LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/commands - trigger.c (source / functions) Hit Total Coverage
Test: PostgreSQL 17devel Lines: 1886 2013 93.7 %
Date: 2024-04-18 22:13:33 Functions: 68 69 98.6 %
Legend: Lines: hit not hit

          Line data    Source code
       1             : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2             :  *
       3             :  * trigger.c
       4             :  *    PostgreSQL TRIGGERs support code.
       5             :  *
       6             :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2024, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
       7             :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
       8             :  *
       9             :  * IDENTIFICATION
      10             :  *    src/backend/commands/trigger.c
      11             :  *
      12             :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      13             :  */
      14             : #include "postgres.h"
      15             : 
      16             : #include "access/genam.h"
      17             : #include "access/htup_details.h"
      18             : #include "access/relation.h"
      19             : #include "access/sysattr.h"
      20             : #include "access/table.h"
      21             : #include "access/tableam.h"
      22             : #include "access/xact.h"
      23             : #include "catalog/catalog.h"
      24             : #include "catalog/dependency.h"
      25             : #include "catalog/indexing.h"
      26             : #include "catalog/objectaccess.h"
      27             : #include "catalog/partition.h"
      28             : #include "catalog/pg_constraint.h"
      29             : #include "catalog/pg_inherits.h"
      30             : #include "catalog/pg_proc.h"
      31             : #include "catalog/pg_trigger.h"
      32             : #include "catalog/pg_type.h"
      33             : #include "commands/dbcommands.h"
      34             : #include "commands/trigger.h"
      35             : #include "executor/executor.h"
      36             : #include "miscadmin.h"
      37             : #include "nodes/bitmapset.h"
      38             : #include "nodes/makefuncs.h"
      39             : #include "optimizer/optimizer.h"
      40             : #include "parser/parse_clause.h"
      41             : #include "parser/parse_collate.h"
      42             : #include "parser/parse_func.h"
      43             : #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
      44             : #include "partitioning/partdesc.h"
      45             : #include "pgstat.h"
      46             : #include "rewrite/rewriteManip.h"
      47             : #include "storage/lmgr.h"
      48             : #include "utils/acl.h"
      49             : #include "utils/builtins.h"
      50             : #include "utils/fmgroids.h"
      51             : #include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
      52             : #include "utils/inval.h"
      53             : #include "utils/lsyscache.h"
      54             : #include "utils/memutils.h"
      55             : #include "utils/plancache.h"
      56             : #include "utils/rel.h"
      57             : #include "utils/snapmgr.h"
      58             : #include "utils/syscache.h"
      59             : #include "utils/tuplestore.h"
      60             : 
      61             : 
      62             : /* GUC variables */
      63             : int         SessionReplicationRole = SESSION_REPLICATION_ROLE_ORIGIN;
      64             : 
      65             : /* How many levels deep into trigger execution are we? */
      66             : static int  MyTriggerDepth = 0;
      67             : 
      68             : /* Local function prototypes */
      69             : static void renametrig_internal(Relation tgrel, Relation targetrel,
      70             :                                 HeapTuple trigtup, const char *newname,
      71             :                                 const char *expected_name);
      72             : static void renametrig_partition(Relation tgrel, Oid partitionId,
      73             :                                  Oid parentTriggerOid, const char *newname,
      74             :                                  const char *expected_name);
      75             : static void SetTriggerFlags(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Trigger *trigger);
      76             : static bool GetTupleForTrigger(EState *estate,
      77             :                                EPQState *epqstate,
      78             :                                ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      79             :                                ItemPointer tid,
      80             :                                LockTupleMode lockmode,
      81             :                                TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
      82             :                                TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
      83             :                                TM_Result *tmresultp,
      84             :                                TM_FailureData *tmfdp);
      85             : static bool TriggerEnabled(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      86             :                            Trigger *trigger, TriggerEvent event,
      87             :                            Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
      88             :                            TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot);
      89             : static HeapTuple ExecCallTriggerFunc(TriggerData *trigdata,
      90             :                                      int tgindx,
      91             :                                      FmgrInfo *finfo,
      92             :                                      Instrumentation *instr,
      93             :                                      MemoryContext per_tuple_context);
      94             : static void AfterTriggerSaveEvent(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
      95             :                                   ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
      96             :                                   ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
      97             :                                   int event, bool row_trigger,
      98             :                                   TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot,
      99             :                                   List *recheckIndexes, Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
     100             :                                   TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
     101             :                                   bool is_crosspart_update);
     102             : static void AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState(void);
     103             : static bool before_stmt_triggers_fired(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType);
     104             : 
     105             : 
     106             : /*
     107             :  * Create a trigger.  Returns the address of the created trigger.
     108             :  *
     109             :  * queryString is the source text of the CREATE TRIGGER command.
     110             :  * This must be supplied if a whenClause is specified, else it can be NULL.
     111             :  *
     112             :  * relOid, if nonzero, is the relation on which the trigger should be
     113             :  * created.  If zero, the name provided in the statement will be looked up.
     114             :  *
     115             :  * refRelOid, if nonzero, is the relation to which the constraint trigger
     116             :  * refers.  If zero, the constraint relation name provided in the statement
     117             :  * will be looked up as needed.
     118             :  *
     119             :  * constraintOid, if nonzero, says that this trigger is being created
     120             :  * internally to implement that constraint.  A suitable pg_depend entry will
     121             :  * be made to link the trigger to that constraint.  constraintOid is zero when
     122             :  * executing a user-entered CREATE TRIGGER command.  (For CREATE CONSTRAINT
     123             :  * TRIGGER, we build a pg_constraint entry internally.)
     124             :  *
     125             :  * indexOid, if nonzero, is the OID of an index associated with the constraint.
     126             :  * We do nothing with this except store it into pg_trigger.tgconstrindid;
     127             :  * but when creating a trigger for a deferrable unique constraint on a
     128             :  * partitioned table, its children are looked up.  Note we don't cope with
     129             :  * invalid indexes in that case.
     130             :  *
     131             :  * funcoid, if nonzero, is the OID of the function to invoke.  When this is
     132             :  * given, stmt->funcname is ignored.
     133             :  *
     134             :  * parentTriggerOid, if nonzero, is a trigger that begets this one; so that
     135             :  * if that trigger is dropped, this one should be too.  There are two cases
     136             :  * when a nonzero value is passed for this: 1) when this function recurses to
     137             :  * create the trigger on partitions, 2) when creating child foreign key
     138             :  * triggers; see CreateFKCheckTrigger() and createForeignKeyActionTriggers().
     139             :  *
     140             :  * If whenClause is passed, it is an already-transformed expression for
     141             :  * WHEN.  In this case, we ignore any that may come in stmt->whenClause.
     142             :  *
     143             :  * If isInternal is true then this is an internally-generated trigger.
     144             :  * This argument sets the tgisinternal field of the pg_trigger entry, and
     145             :  * if true causes us to modify the given trigger name to ensure uniqueness.
     146             :  *
     147             :  * When isInternal is not true we require ACL_TRIGGER permissions on the
     148             :  * relation, as well as ACL_EXECUTE on the trigger function.  For internal
     149             :  * triggers the caller must apply any required permission checks.
     150             :  *
     151             :  * When called on partitioned tables, this function recurses to create the
     152             :  * trigger on all the partitions, except if isInternal is true, in which
     153             :  * case caller is expected to execute recursion on its own.  in_partition
     154             :  * indicates such a recursive call; outside callers should pass "false"
     155             :  * (but see CloneRowTriggersToPartition).
     156             :  */
     157             : ObjectAddress
     158       14264 : CreateTrigger(CreateTrigStmt *stmt, const char *queryString,
     159             :               Oid relOid, Oid refRelOid, Oid constraintOid, Oid indexOid,
     160             :               Oid funcoid, Oid parentTriggerOid, Node *whenClause,
     161             :               bool isInternal, bool in_partition)
     162             : {
     163             :     return
     164       14264 :         CreateTriggerFiringOn(stmt, queryString, relOid, refRelOid,
     165             :                               constraintOid, indexOid, funcoid,
     166             :                               parentTriggerOid, whenClause, isInternal,
     167             :                               in_partition, TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_ORIGIN);
     168             : }
     169             : 
     170             : /*
     171             :  * Like the above; additionally the firing condition
     172             :  * (always/origin/replica/disabled) can be specified.
     173             :  */
     174             : ObjectAddress
     175       15140 : CreateTriggerFiringOn(CreateTrigStmt *stmt, const char *queryString,
     176             :                       Oid relOid, Oid refRelOid, Oid constraintOid,
     177             :                       Oid indexOid, Oid funcoid, Oid parentTriggerOid,
     178             :                       Node *whenClause, bool isInternal, bool in_partition,
     179             :                       char trigger_fires_when)
     180             : {
     181             :     int16       tgtype;
     182             :     int         ncolumns;
     183             :     int16      *columns;
     184             :     int2vector *tgattr;
     185             :     List       *whenRtable;
     186             :     char       *qual;
     187             :     Datum       values[Natts_pg_trigger];
     188             :     bool        nulls[Natts_pg_trigger];
     189             :     Relation    rel;
     190             :     AclResult   aclresult;
     191             :     Relation    tgrel;
     192             :     Relation    pgrel;
     193       15140 :     HeapTuple   tuple = NULL;
     194             :     Oid         funcrettype;
     195       15140 :     Oid         trigoid = InvalidOid;
     196             :     char        internaltrigname[NAMEDATALEN];
     197             :     char       *trigname;
     198       15140 :     Oid         constrrelid = InvalidOid;
     199             :     ObjectAddress myself,
     200             :                 referenced;
     201       15140 :     char       *oldtablename = NULL;
     202       15140 :     char       *newtablename = NULL;
     203             :     bool        partition_recurse;
     204       15140 :     bool        trigger_exists = false;
     205       15140 :     Oid         existing_constraint_oid = InvalidOid;
     206       15140 :     bool        existing_isInternal = false;
     207       15140 :     bool        existing_isClone = false;
     208             : 
     209       15140 :     if (OidIsValid(relOid))
     210       12030 :         rel = table_open(relOid, ShareRowExclusiveLock);
     211             :     else
     212        3110 :         rel = table_openrv(stmt->relation, ShareRowExclusiveLock);
     213             : 
     214             :     /*
     215             :      * Triggers must be on tables or views, and there are additional
     216             :      * relation-type-specific restrictions.
     217             :      */
     218       15140 :     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_RELATION)
     219             :     {
     220             :         /* Tables can't have INSTEAD OF triggers */
     221       12570 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     222       11282 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     223          18 :             ereport(ERROR,
     224             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     225             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a table",
     226             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     227             :                      errdetail("Tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     228             :     }
     229        2570 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
     230             :     {
     231             :         /* Partitioned tables can't have INSTEAD OF triggers */
     232        2262 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     233        2160 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     234           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     235             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     236             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a table",
     237             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     238             :                      errdetail("Tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     239             : 
     240             :         /*
     241             :          * FOR EACH ROW triggers have further restrictions
     242             :          */
     243        2256 :         if (stmt->row)
     244             :         {
     245             :             /*
     246             :              * Disallow use of transition tables.
     247             :              *
     248             :              * Note that we have another restriction about transition tables
     249             :              * in partitions; search for 'has_superclass' below for an
     250             :              * explanation.  The check here is just to protect from the fact
     251             :              * that if we allowed it here, the creation would succeed for a
     252             :              * partitioned table with no partitions, but would be blocked by
     253             :              * the other restriction when the first partition was created,
     254             :              * which is very unfriendly behavior.
     255             :              */
     256        2038 :             if (stmt->transitionRels != NIL)
     257           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     258             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     259             :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a partitioned table",
     260             :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     261             :                          errdetail("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on partitioned tables.")));
     262             :         }
     263             :     }
     264         308 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_VIEW)
     265             :     {
     266             :         /*
     267             :          * Views can have INSTEAD OF triggers (which we check below are
     268             :          * row-level), or statement-level BEFORE/AFTER triggers.
     269             :          */
     270         204 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD && stmt->row)
     271          36 :             ereport(ERROR,
     272             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     273             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     274             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     275             :                      errdetail("Views cannot have row-level BEFORE or AFTER triggers.")));
     276             :         /* Disallow TRUNCATE triggers on VIEWs */
     277         168 :         if (TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(stmt->events))
     278          12 :             ereport(ERROR,
     279             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     280             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     281             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     282             :                      errdetail("Views cannot have TRUNCATE triggers.")));
     283             :     }
     284         104 :     else if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
     285             :     {
     286         104 :         if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE &&
     287          54 :             stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     288           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     289             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     290             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     291             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     292             :                      errdetail("Foreign tables cannot have INSTEAD OF triggers.")));
     293             : 
     294             :         /*
     295             :          * We disallow constraint triggers to protect the assumption that
     296             :          * triggers on FKs can't be deferred.  See notes with AfterTriggers
     297             :          * data structures, below.
     298             :          */
     299         104 :         if (stmt->isconstraint)
     300           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     301             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     302             :                      errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     303             :                             RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     304             :                      errdetail("Foreign tables cannot have constraint triggers.")));
     305             :     }
     306             :     else
     307           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     308             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     309             :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
     310             :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     311             :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(rel->rd_rel->relkind)));
     312             : 
     313       15056 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemRelation(rel))
     314           2 :         ereport(ERROR,
     315             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
     316             :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
     317             :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     318             : 
     319       15054 :     if (stmt->isconstraint)
     320             :     {
     321             :         /*
     322             :          * We must take a lock on the target relation to protect against
     323             :          * concurrent drop.  It's not clear that AccessShareLock is strong
     324             :          * enough, but we certainly need at least that much... otherwise, we
     325             :          * might end up creating a pg_constraint entry referencing a
     326             :          * nonexistent table.
     327             :          */
     328       11304 :         if (OidIsValid(refRelOid))
     329             :         {
     330       11034 :             LockRelationOid(refRelOid, AccessShareLock);
     331       11034 :             constrrelid = refRelOid;
     332             :         }
     333         270 :         else if (stmt->constrrel != NULL)
     334          24 :             constrrelid = RangeVarGetRelid(stmt->constrrel, AccessShareLock,
     335             :                                            false);
     336             :     }
     337             : 
     338             :     /* permission checks */
     339       15054 :     if (!isInternal)
     340             :     {
     341        3900 :         aclresult = pg_class_aclcheck(RelationGetRelid(rel), GetUserId(),
     342             :                                       ACL_TRIGGER);
     343        3900 :         if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     344           0 :             aclcheck_error(aclresult, get_relkind_objtype(rel->rd_rel->relkind),
     345           0 :                            RelationGetRelationName(rel));
     346             : 
     347        3900 :         if (OidIsValid(constrrelid))
     348             :         {
     349          42 :             aclresult = pg_class_aclcheck(constrrelid, GetUserId(),
     350             :                                           ACL_TRIGGER);
     351          42 :             if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     352           0 :                 aclcheck_error(aclresult, get_relkind_objtype(get_rel_relkind(constrrelid)),
     353           0 :                                get_rel_name(constrrelid));
     354             :         }
     355             :     }
     356             : 
     357             :     /*
     358             :      * When called on a partitioned table to create a FOR EACH ROW trigger
     359             :      * that's not internal, we create one trigger for each partition, too.
     360             :      *
     361             :      * For that, we'd better hold lock on all of them ahead of time.
     362             :      */
     363       17966 :     partition_recurse = !isInternal && stmt->row &&
     364        2912 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE;
     365       15054 :     if (partition_recurse)
     366         410 :         list_free(find_all_inheritors(RelationGetRelid(rel),
     367             :                                       ShareRowExclusiveLock, NULL));
     368             : 
     369             :     /* Compute tgtype */
     370       15054 :     TRIGGER_CLEAR_TYPE(tgtype);
     371       15054 :     if (stmt->row)
     372       14066 :         TRIGGER_SETT_ROW(tgtype);
     373       15054 :     tgtype |= stmt->timing;
     374       15054 :     tgtype |= stmt->events;
     375             : 
     376             :     /* Disallow ROW-level TRUNCATE triggers */
     377       15054 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype) && TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(tgtype))
     378           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     379             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     380             :                  errmsg("TRUNCATE FOR EACH ROW triggers are not supported")));
     381             : 
     382             :     /* INSTEAD triggers must be row-level, and can't have WHEN or columns */
     383       15054 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_INSTEAD(tgtype))
     384             :     {
     385         114 :         if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     386           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     387             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     388             :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers must be FOR EACH ROW")));
     389         108 :         if (stmt->whenClause)
     390           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     391             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     392             :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers cannot have WHEN conditions")));
     393         102 :         if (stmt->columns != NIL)
     394           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     395             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     396             :                      errmsg("INSTEAD OF triggers cannot have column lists")));
     397             :     }
     398             : 
     399             :     /*
     400             :      * We don't yet support naming ROW transition variables, but the parser
     401             :      * recognizes the syntax so we can give a nicer message here.
     402             :      *
     403             :      * Per standard, REFERENCING TABLE names are only allowed on AFTER
     404             :      * triggers.  Per standard, REFERENCING ROW names are not allowed with FOR
     405             :      * EACH STATEMENT.  Per standard, each OLD/NEW, ROW/TABLE permutation is
     406             :      * only allowed once.  Per standard, OLD may not be specified when
     407             :      * creating a trigger only for INSERT, and NEW may not be specified when
     408             :      * creating a trigger only for DELETE.
     409             :      *
     410             :      * Notice that the standard allows an AFTER ... FOR EACH ROW trigger to
     411             :      * reference both ROW and TABLE transition data.
     412             :      */
     413       15036 :     if (stmt->transitionRels != NIL)
     414             :     {
     415         418 :         List       *varList = stmt->transitionRels;
     416             :         ListCell   *lc;
     417             : 
     418         914 :         foreach(lc, varList)
     419             :         {
     420         544 :             TriggerTransition *tt = lfirst_node(TriggerTransition, lc);
     421             : 
     422         544 :             if (!(tt->isTable))
     423           0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     424             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     425             :                          errmsg("ROW variable naming in the REFERENCING clause is not supported"),
     426             :                          errhint("Use OLD TABLE or NEW TABLE for naming transition tables.")));
     427             : 
     428             :             /*
     429             :              * Because of the above test, we omit further ROW-related testing
     430             :              * below.  If we later allow naming OLD and NEW ROW variables,
     431             :              * adjustments will be needed below.
     432             :              */
     433             : 
     434         544 :             if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
     435           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     436             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     437             :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a foreign table",
     438             :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     439             :                          errdetail("Triggers on foreign tables cannot have transition tables.")));
     440             : 
     441         538 :             if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_VIEW)
     442           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     443             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
     444             :                          errmsg("\"%s\" is a view",
     445             :                                 RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
     446             :                          errdetail("Triggers on views cannot have transition tables.")));
     447             : 
     448             :             /*
     449             :              * We currently don't allow row-level triggers with transition
     450             :              * tables on partition or inheritance children.  Such triggers
     451             :              * would somehow need to see tuples converted to the format of the
     452             :              * table they're attached to, and it's not clear which subset of
     453             :              * tuples each child should see.  See also the prohibitions in
     454             :              * ATExecAttachPartition() and ATExecAddInherit().
     455             :              */
     456         532 :             if (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype) && has_superclass(rel->rd_id))
     457             :             {
     458             :                 /* Use appropriate error message. */
     459          12 :                 if (rel->rd_rel->relispartition)
     460           6 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     461             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     462             :                              errmsg("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on partitions")));
     463             :                 else
     464           6 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     465             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     466             :                              errmsg("ROW triggers with transition tables are not supported on inheritance children")));
     467             :             }
     468             : 
     469         520 :             if (stmt->timing != TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER)
     470           0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     471             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     472             :                          errmsg("transition table name can only be specified for an AFTER trigger")));
     473             : 
     474         520 :             if (TRIGGER_FOR_TRUNCATE(tgtype))
     475           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     476             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     477             :                          errmsg("TRUNCATE triggers with transition tables are not supported")));
     478             : 
     479             :             /*
     480             :              * We currently don't allow multi-event triggers ("INSERT OR
     481             :              * UPDATE") with transition tables, because it's not clear how to
     482             :              * handle INSERT ... ON CONFLICT statements which can fire both
     483             :              * INSERT and UPDATE triggers.  We show the inserted tuples to
     484             :              * INSERT triggers and the updated tuples to UPDATE triggers, but
     485             :              * it's not yet clear what INSERT OR UPDATE trigger should see.
     486             :              * This restriction could be lifted if we can decide on the right
     487             :              * semantics in a later release.
     488             :              */
     489         514 :             if (((TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) ? 1 : 0) +
     490         514 :                  (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) ? 1 : 0) +
     491         514 :                  (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) ? 1 : 0)) != 1)
     492           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     493             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     494             :                          errmsg("transition tables cannot be specified for triggers with more than one event")));
     495             : 
     496             :             /*
     497             :              * We currently don't allow column-specific triggers with
     498             :              * transition tables.  Per spec, that seems to require
     499             :              * accumulating separate transition tables for each combination of
     500             :              * columns, which is a lot of work for a rather marginal feature.
     501             :              */
     502         508 :             if (stmt->columns != NIL)
     503           6 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     504             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     505             :                          errmsg("transition tables cannot be specified for triggers with column lists")));
     506             : 
     507             :             /*
     508             :              * We disallow constraint triggers with transition tables, to
     509             :              * protect the assumption that such triggers can't be deferred.
     510             :              * See notes with AfterTriggers data structures, below.
     511             :              *
     512             :              * Currently this is enforced by the grammar, so just Assert here.
     513             :              */
     514             :             Assert(!stmt->isconstraint);
     515             : 
     516         502 :             if (tt->isNew)
     517             :             {
     518         264 :                 if (!(TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) ||
     519         146 :                       TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype)))
     520           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     521             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     522             :                              errmsg("NEW TABLE can only be specified for an INSERT or UPDATE trigger")));
     523             : 
     524         264 :                 if (newtablename != NULL)
     525           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     526             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     527             :                              errmsg("NEW TABLE cannot be specified multiple times")));
     528             : 
     529         264 :                 newtablename = tt->name;
     530             :             }
     531             :             else
     532             :             {
     533         238 :                 if (!(TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) ||
     534         140 :                       TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype)))
     535           6 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     536             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     537             :                              errmsg("OLD TABLE can only be specified for a DELETE or UPDATE trigger")));
     538             : 
     539         232 :                 if (oldtablename != NULL)
     540           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     541             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     542             :                              errmsg("OLD TABLE cannot be specified multiple times")));
     543             : 
     544         232 :                 oldtablename = tt->name;
     545             :             }
     546             :         }
     547             : 
     548         370 :         if (newtablename != NULL && oldtablename != NULL &&
     549         126 :             strcmp(newtablename, oldtablename) == 0)
     550           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     551             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     552             :                      errmsg("OLD TABLE name and NEW TABLE name cannot be the same")));
     553             :     }
     554             : 
     555             :     /*
     556             :      * Parse the WHEN clause, if any and we weren't passed an already
     557             :      * transformed one.
     558             :      *
     559             :      * Note that as a side effect, we fill whenRtable when parsing.  If we got
     560             :      * an already parsed clause, this does not occur, which is what we want --
     561             :      * no point in adding redundant dependencies below.
     562             :      */
     563       14988 :     if (!whenClause && stmt->whenClause)
     564         110 :     {
     565             :         ParseState *pstate;
     566             :         ParseNamespaceItem *nsitem;
     567             :         List       *varList;
     568             :         ListCell   *lc;
     569             : 
     570             :         /* Set up a pstate to parse with */
     571         146 :         pstate = make_parsestate(NULL);
     572         146 :         pstate->p_sourcetext = queryString;
     573             : 
     574             :         /*
     575             :          * Set up nsitems for OLD and NEW references.
     576             :          *
     577             :          * 'OLD' must always have varno equal to 1 and 'NEW' equal to 2.
     578             :          */
     579         146 :         nsitem = addRangeTableEntryForRelation(pstate, rel,
     580             :                                                AccessShareLock,
     581             :                                                makeAlias("old", NIL),
     582             :                                                false, false);
     583         146 :         addNSItemToQuery(pstate, nsitem, false, true, true);
     584         146 :         nsitem = addRangeTableEntryForRelation(pstate, rel,
     585             :                                                AccessShareLock,
     586             :                                                makeAlias("new", NIL),
     587             :                                                false, false);
     588         146 :         addNSItemToQuery(pstate, nsitem, false, true, true);
     589             : 
     590             :         /* Transform expression.  Copy to be sure we don't modify original */
     591         146 :         whenClause = transformWhereClause(pstate,
     592         146 :                                           copyObject(stmt->whenClause),
     593             :                                           EXPR_KIND_TRIGGER_WHEN,
     594             :                                           "WHEN");
     595             :         /* we have to fix its collations too */
     596         146 :         assign_expr_collations(pstate, whenClause);
     597             : 
     598             :         /*
     599             :          * Check for disallowed references to OLD/NEW.
     600             :          *
     601             :          * NB: pull_var_clause is okay here only because we don't allow
     602             :          * subselects in WHEN clauses; it would fail to examine the contents
     603             :          * of subselects.
     604             :          */
     605         146 :         varList = pull_var_clause(whenClause, 0);
     606         300 :         foreach(lc, varList)
     607             :         {
     608         190 :             Var        *var = (Var *) lfirst(lc);
     609             : 
     610         190 :             switch (var->varno)
     611             :             {
     612          74 :                 case PRS2_OLD_VARNO:
     613          74 :                     if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     614           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     615             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     616             :                                  errmsg("statement trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference column values"),
     617             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     618          68 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype))
     619           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     620             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     621             :                                  errmsg("INSERT trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference OLD values"),
     622             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     623             :                     /* system columns are okay here */
     624          62 :                     break;
     625         116 :                 case PRS2_NEW_VARNO:
     626         116 :                     if (!TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(tgtype))
     627           0 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     628             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     629             :                                  errmsg("statement trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference column values"),
     630             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     631         116 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype))
     632           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     633             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     634             :                                  errmsg("DELETE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW values"),
     635             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     636         110 :                     if (var->varattno < 0 && TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype))
     637           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     638             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
     639             :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW system columns"),
     640             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     641         104 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype) &&
     642          34 :                         var->varattno == 0 &&
     643          12 :                         RelationGetDescr(rel)->constr &&
     644           6 :                         RelationGetDescr(rel)->constr->has_generated_stored)
     645           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     646             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     647             :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW generated columns"),
     648             :                                  errdetail("A whole-row reference is used and the table contains generated columns."),
     649             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     650          98 :                     if (TRIGGER_FOR_BEFORE(tgtype) &&
     651          28 :                         var->varattno > 0 &&
     652          22 :                         TupleDescAttr(RelationGetDescr(rel), var->varattno - 1)->attgenerated)
     653           6 :                         ereport(ERROR,
     654             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     655             :                                  errmsg("BEFORE trigger's WHEN condition cannot reference NEW generated columns"),
     656             :                                  errdetail("Column \"%s\" is a generated column.",
     657             :                                            NameStr(TupleDescAttr(RelationGetDescr(rel), var->varattno - 1)->attname)),
     658             :                                  parser_errposition(pstate, var->location)));
     659          92 :                     break;
     660           0 :                 default:
     661             :                     /* can't happen without add_missing_from, so just elog */
     662           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "trigger WHEN condition cannot contain references to other relations");
     663             :                     break;
     664             :             }
     665             :         }
     666             : 
     667             :         /* we'll need the rtable for recordDependencyOnExpr */
     668         110 :         whenRtable = pstate->p_rtable;
     669             : 
     670         110 :         qual = nodeToString(whenClause);
     671             : 
     672         110 :         free_parsestate(pstate);
     673             :     }
     674       14842 :     else if (!whenClause)
     675             :     {
     676       14800 :         whenClause = NULL;
     677       14800 :         whenRtable = NIL;
     678       14800 :         qual = NULL;
     679             :     }
     680             :     else
     681             :     {
     682          42 :         qual = nodeToString(whenClause);
     683          42 :         whenRtable = NIL;
     684             :     }
     685             : 
     686             :     /*
     687             :      * Find and validate the trigger function.
     688             :      */
     689       14952 :     if (!OidIsValid(funcoid))
     690       14076 :         funcoid = LookupFuncName(stmt->funcname, 0, NULL, false);
     691       14952 :     if (!isInternal)
     692             :     {
     693        3798 :         aclresult = object_aclcheck(ProcedureRelationId, funcoid, GetUserId(), ACL_EXECUTE);
     694        3798 :         if (aclresult != ACLCHECK_OK)
     695           0 :             aclcheck_error(aclresult, OBJECT_FUNCTION,
     696           0 :                            NameListToString(stmt->funcname));
     697             :     }
     698       14952 :     funcrettype = get_func_rettype(funcoid);
     699       14952 :     if (funcrettype != TRIGGEROID)
     700           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
     701             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_OBJECT_DEFINITION),
     702             :                  errmsg("function %s must return type %s",
     703             :                         NameListToString(stmt->funcname), "trigger")));
     704             : 
     705             :     /*
     706             :      * Scan pg_trigger to see if there is already a trigger of the same name.
     707             :      * Skip this for internally generated triggers, since we'll modify the
     708             :      * name to be unique below.
     709             :      *
     710             :      * NOTE that this is cool only because we have ShareRowExclusiveLock on
     711             :      * the relation, so the trigger set won't be changing underneath us.
     712             :      */
     713       14952 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
     714       14952 :     if (!isInternal)
     715             :     {
     716             :         ScanKeyData skeys[2];
     717             :         SysScanDesc tgscan;
     718             : 
     719        3798 :         ScanKeyInit(&skeys[0],
     720             :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
     721             :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
     722             :                     ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
     723             : 
     724        3798 :         ScanKeyInit(&skeys[1],
     725             :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
     726             :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
     727        3798 :                     CStringGetDatum(stmt->trigname));
     728             : 
     729        3798 :         tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
     730             :                                     NULL, 2, skeys);
     731             : 
     732             :         /* There should be at most one matching tuple */
     733        3798 :         if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
     734             :         {
     735         102 :             Form_pg_trigger oldtrigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
     736             : 
     737         102 :             trigoid = oldtrigger->oid;
     738         102 :             existing_constraint_oid = oldtrigger->tgconstraint;
     739         102 :             existing_isInternal = oldtrigger->tgisinternal;
     740         102 :             existing_isClone = OidIsValid(oldtrigger->tgparentid);
     741         102 :             trigger_exists = true;
     742             :             /* copy the tuple to use in CatalogTupleUpdate() */
     743         102 :             tuple = heap_copytuple(tuple);
     744             :         }
     745        3798 :         systable_endscan(tgscan);
     746             :     }
     747             : 
     748       14952 :     if (!trigger_exists)
     749             :     {
     750             :         /* Generate the OID for the new trigger. */
     751       14850 :         trigoid = GetNewOidWithIndex(tgrel, TriggerOidIndexId,
     752             :                                      Anum_pg_trigger_oid);
     753             :     }
     754             :     else
     755             :     {
     756             :         /*
     757             :          * If OR REPLACE was specified, we'll replace the old trigger;
     758             :          * otherwise complain about the duplicate name.
     759             :          */
     760         102 :         if (!stmt->replace)
     761          18 :             ereport(ERROR,
     762             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     763             :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" already exists",
     764             :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     765             : 
     766             :         /*
     767             :          * An internal trigger or a child trigger (isClone) cannot be replaced
     768             :          * by a user-defined trigger.  However, skip this test when
     769             :          * in_partition, because then we're recursing from a partitioned table
     770             :          * and the check was made at the parent level.
     771             :          */
     772          84 :         if ((existing_isInternal || existing_isClone) &&
     773          60 :             !isInternal && !in_partition)
     774           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
     775             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     776             :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" is an internal or a child trigger",
     777             :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     778             : 
     779             :         /*
     780             :          * It is not allowed to replace with a constraint trigger; gram.y
     781             :          * should have enforced this already.
     782             :          */
     783             :         Assert(!stmt->isconstraint);
     784             : 
     785             :         /*
     786             :          * It is not allowed to replace an existing constraint trigger,
     787             :          * either.  (The reason for these restrictions is partly that it seems
     788             :          * difficult to deal with pending trigger events in such cases, and
     789             :          * partly that the command might imply changing the constraint's
     790             :          * properties as well, which doesn't seem nice.)
     791             :          */
     792          78 :         if (OidIsValid(existing_constraint_oid))
     793           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
     794             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
     795             :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" is a constraint trigger",
     796             :                             stmt->trigname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     797             :     }
     798             : 
     799             :     /*
     800             :      * If it's a user-entered CREATE CONSTRAINT TRIGGER command, make a
     801             :      * corresponding pg_constraint entry.
     802             :      */
     803       14928 :     if (stmt->isconstraint && !OidIsValid(constraintOid))
     804             :     {
     805             :         /* Internal callers should have made their own constraints */
     806             :         Assert(!isInternal);
     807         150 :         constraintOid = CreateConstraintEntry(stmt->trigname,
     808         150 :                                               RelationGetNamespace(rel),
     809             :                                               CONSTRAINT_TRIGGER,
     810         150 :                                               stmt->deferrable,
     811         150 :                                               stmt->initdeferred,
     812             :                                               true,
     813             :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no parent */
     814             :                                               RelationGetRelid(rel),
     815             :                                               NULL, /* no conkey */
     816             :                                               0,
     817             :                                               0,
     818             :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no domain */
     819             :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no index */
     820             :                                               InvalidOid,   /* no foreign key */
     821             :                                               NULL,
     822             :                                               NULL,
     823             :                                               NULL,
     824             :                                               NULL,
     825             :                                               0,
     826             :                                               ' ',
     827             :                                               ' ',
     828             :                                               NULL,
     829             :                                               0,
     830             :                                               ' ',
     831             :                                               NULL, /* no exclusion */
     832             :                                               NULL, /* no check constraint */
     833             :                                               NULL,
     834             :                                               true, /* islocal */
     835             :                                               0,    /* inhcount */
     836             :                                               true, /* noinherit */
     837             :                                               false,    /* conperiod */
     838             :                                               isInternal);  /* is_internal */
     839             :     }
     840             : 
     841             :     /*
     842             :      * If trigger is internally generated, modify the provided trigger name to
     843             :      * ensure uniqueness by appending the trigger OID.  (Callers will usually
     844             :      * supply a simple constant trigger name in these cases.)
     845             :      */
     846       14928 :     if (isInternal)
     847             :     {
     848       11154 :         snprintf(internaltrigname, sizeof(internaltrigname),
     849             :                  "%s_%u", stmt->trigname, trigoid);
     850       11154 :         trigname = internaltrigname;
     851             :     }
     852             :     else
     853             :     {
     854             :         /* user-defined trigger; use the specified trigger name as-is */
     855        3774 :         trigname = stmt->trigname;
     856             :     }
     857             : 
     858             :     /*
     859             :      * Build the new pg_trigger tuple.
     860             :      */
     861       14928 :     memset(nulls, false, sizeof(nulls));
     862             : 
     863       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_oid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(trigoid);
     864       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel));
     865       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgparentid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(parentTriggerOid);
     866       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgname - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     867             :                                                              CStringGetDatum(trigname));
     868       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgfoid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(funcoid);
     869       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgtype - 1] = Int16GetDatum(tgtype);
     870       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgenabled - 1] = trigger_fires_when;
     871       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgisinternal - 1] = BoolGetDatum(isInternal);
     872       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstrrelid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(constrrelid);
     873       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstrindid - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(indexOid);
     874       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstraint - 1] = ObjectIdGetDatum(constraintOid);
     875       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgdeferrable - 1] = BoolGetDatum(stmt->deferrable);
     876       14928 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tginitdeferred - 1] = BoolGetDatum(stmt->initdeferred);
     877             : 
     878       14928 :     if (stmt->args)
     879             :     {
     880             :         ListCell   *le;
     881             :         char       *args;
     882         568 :         int16       nargs = list_length(stmt->args);
     883         568 :         int         len = 0;
     884             : 
     885        1418 :         foreach(le, stmt->args)
     886             :         {
     887         850 :             char       *ar = strVal(lfirst(le));
     888             : 
     889         850 :             len += strlen(ar) + 4;
     890        7082 :             for (; *ar; ar++)
     891             :             {
     892        6232 :                 if (*ar == '\\')
     893           0 :                     len++;
     894             :             }
     895             :         }
     896         568 :         args = (char *) palloc(len + 1);
     897         568 :         args[0] = '\0';
     898        1418 :         foreach(le, stmt->args)
     899             :         {
     900         850 :             char       *s = strVal(lfirst(le));
     901         850 :             char       *d = args + strlen(args);
     902             : 
     903        7082 :             while (*s)
     904             :             {
     905        6232 :                 if (*s == '\\')
     906           0 :                     *d++ = '\\';
     907        6232 :                 *d++ = *s++;
     908             :             }
     909         850 :             strcpy(d, "\\000");
     910             :         }
     911         568 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnargs - 1] = Int16GetDatum(nargs);
     912         568 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(byteain,
     913             :                                                                  CStringGetDatum(args));
     914             :     }
     915             :     else
     916             :     {
     917       14360 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnargs - 1] = Int16GetDatum(0);
     918       14360 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(byteain,
     919             :                                                                  CStringGetDatum(""));
     920             :     }
     921             : 
     922             :     /* build column number array if it's a column-specific trigger */
     923       14928 :     ncolumns = list_length(stmt->columns);
     924       14928 :     if (ncolumns == 0)
     925       14828 :         columns = NULL;
     926             :     else
     927             :     {
     928             :         ListCell   *cell;
     929         100 :         int         i = 0;
     930             : 
     931         100 :         columns = (int16 *) palloc(ncolumns * sizeof(int16));
     932         208 :         foreach(cell, stmt->columns)
     933             :         {
     934         114 :             char       *name = strVal(lfirst(cell));
     935             :             int16       attnum;
     936             :             int         j;
     937             : 
     938             :             /* Lookup column name.  System columns are not allowed */
     939         114 :             attnum = attnameAttNum(rel, name, false);
     940         114 :             if (attnum == InvalidAttrNumber)
     941           0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
     942             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_COLUMN),
     943             :                          errmsg("column \"%s\" of relation \"%s\" does not exist",
     944             :                                 name, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
     945             : 
     946             :             /* Check for duplicates */
     947         122 :             for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j--)
     948             :             {
     949          14 :                 if (columns[j] == attnum)
     950           6 :                     ereport(ERROR,
     951             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_COLUMN),
     952             :                              errmsg("column \"%s\" specified more than once",
     953             :                                     name)));
     954             :             }
     955             : 
     956         108 :             columns[i++] = attnum;
     957             :         }
     958             :     }
     959       14922 :     tgattr = buildint2vector(columns, ncolumns);
     960       14922 :     values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgattr - 1] = PointerGetDatum(tgattr);
     961             : 
     962             :     /* set tgqual if trigger has WHEN clause */
     963       14922 :     if (qual)
     964         152 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual - 1] = CStringGetTextDatum(qual);
     965             :     else
     966       14770 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual - 1] = true;
     967             : 
     968       14922 :     if (oldtablename)
     969         232 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     970             :                                                                      CStringGetDatum(oldtablename));
     971             :     else
     972       14690 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1] = true;
     973       14922 :     if (newtablename)
     974         264 :         values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1] = DirectFunctionCall1(namein,
     975             :                                                                      CStringGetDatum(newtablename));
     976             :     else
     977       14658 :         nulls[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1] = true;
     978             : 
     979             :     /*
     980             :      * Insert or replace tuple in pg_trigger.
     981             :      */
     982       14922 :     if (!trigger_exists)
     983             :     {
     984       14844 :         tuple = heap_form_tuple(tgrel->rd_att, values, nulls);
     985       14844 :         CatalogTupleInsert(tgrel, tuple);
     986             :     }
     987             :     else
     988             :     {
     989             :         HeapTuple   newtup;
     990             : 
     991          78 :         newtup = heap_form_tuple(tgrel->rd_att, values, nulls);
     992          78 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
     993          78 :         heap_freetuple(newtup);
     994             :     }
     995             : 
     996       14922 :     heap_freetuple(tuple);      /* free either original or new tuple */
     997       14922 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
     998             : 
     999       14922 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgname - 1]));
    1000       14922 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs - 1]));
    1001       14922 :     pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgattr - 1]));
    1002       14922 :     if (oldtablename)
    1003         232 :         pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable - 1]));
    1004       14922 :     if (newtablename)
    1005         264 :         pfree(DatumGetPointer(values[Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable - 1]));
    1006             : 
    1007             :     /*
    1008             :      * Update relation's pg_class entry; if necessary; and if not, send an SI
    1009             :      * message to make other backends (and this one) rebuild relcache entries.
    1010             :      */
    1011       14922 :     pgrel = table_open(RelationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1012       14922 :     tuple = SearchSysCacheCopy1(RELOID,
    1013             :                                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
    1014       14922 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1015           0 :         elog(ERROR, "cache lookup failed for relation %u",
    1016             :              RelationGetRelid(rel));
    1017       14922 :     if (!((Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple))->relhastriggers)
    1018             :     {
    1019        5996 :         ((Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple))->relhastriggers = true;
    1020             : 
    1021        5996 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(pgrel, &tuple->t_self, tuple);
    1022             : 
    1023        5996 :         CommandCounterIncrement();
    1024             :     }
    1025             :     else
    1026        8926 :         CacheInvalidateRelcacheByTuple(tuple);
    1027             : 
    1028       14922 :     heap_freetuple(tuple);
    1029       14922 :     table_close(pgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1030             : 
    1031             :     /*
    1032             :      * If we're replacing a trigger, flush all the old dependencies before
    1033             :      * recording new ones.
    1034             :      */
    1035       14922 :     if (trigger_exists)
    1036          78 :         deleteDependencyRecordsFor(TriggerRelationId, trigoid, true);
    1037             : 
    1038             :     /*
    1039             :      * Record dependencies for trigger.  Always place a normal dependency on
    1040             :      * the function.
    1041             :      */
    1042       14922 :     myself.classId = TriggerRelationId;
    1043       14922 :     myself.objectId = trigoid;
    1044       14922 :     myself.objectSubId = 0;
    1045             : 
    1046       14922 :     referenced.classId = ProcedureRelationId;
    1047       14922 :     referenced.objectId = funcoid;
    1048       14922 :     referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1049       14922 :     recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1050             : 
    1051       14922 :     if (isInternal && OidIsValid(constraintOid))
    1052             :     {
    1053             :         /*
    1054             :          * Internally-generated trigger for a constraint, so make it an
    1055             :          * internal dependency of the constraint.  We can skip depending on
    1056             :          * the relation(s), as there'll be an indirect dependency via the
    1057             :          * constraint.
    1058             :          */
    1059       11154 :         referenced.classId = ConstraintRelationId;
    1060       11154 :         referenced.objectId = constraintOid;
    1061       11154 :         referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1062       11154 :         recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_INTERNAL);
    1063             :     }
    1064             :     else
    1065             :     {
    1066             :         /*
    1067             :          * User CREATE TRIGGER, so place dependencies.  We make trigger be
    1068             :          * auto-dropped if its relation is dropped or if the FK relation is
    1069             :          * dropped.  (Auto drop is compatible with our pre-7.3 behavior.)
    1070             :          */
    1071        3768 :         referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1072        3768 :         referenced.objectId = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    1073        3768 :         referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1074        3768 :         recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_AUTO);
    1075             : 
    1076        3768 :         if (OidIsValid(constrrelid))
    1077             :         {
    1078          42 :             referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1079          42 :             referenced.objectId = constrrelid;
    1080          42 :             referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1081          42 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_AUTO);
    1082             :         }
    1083             :         /* Not possible to have an index dependency in this case */
    1084             :         Assert(!OidIsValid(indexOid));
    1085             : 
    1086             :         /*
    1087             :          * If it's a user-specified constraint trigger, make the constraint
    1088             :          * internally dependent on the trigger instead of vice versa.
    1089             :          */
    1090        3768 :         if (OidIsValid(constraintOid))
    1091             :         {
    1092         150 :             referenced.classId = ConstraintRelationId;
    1093         150 :             referenced.objectId = constraintOid;
    1094         150 :             referenced.objectSubId = 0;
    1095         150 :             recordDependencyOn(&referenced, &myself, DEPENDENCY_INTERNAL);
    1096             :         }
    1097             : 
    1098             :         /*
    1099             :          * If it's a partition trigger, create the partition dependencies.
    1100             :          */
    1101        3768 :         if (OidIsValid(parentTriggerOid))
    1102             :         {
    1103         864 :             ObjectAddressSet(referenced, TriggerRelationId, parentTriggerOid);
    1104         864 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1105         864 :             ObjectAddressSet(referenced, RelationRelationId, RelationGetRelid(rel));
    1106         864 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1107             :         }
    1108             :     }
    1109             : 
    1110             :     /* If column-specific trigger, add normal dependencies on columns */
    1111       14922 :     if (columns != NULL)
    1112             :     {
    1113             :         int         i;
    1114             : 
    1115          94 :         referenced.classId = RelationRelationId;
    1116          94 :         referenced.objectId = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    1117         196 :         for (i = 0; i < ncolumns; i++)
    1118             :         {
    1119         102 :             referenced.objectSubId = columns[i];
    1120         102 :             recordDependencyOn(&myself, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1121             :         }
    1122             :     }
    1123             : 
    1124             :     /*
    1125             :      * If it has a WHEN clause, add dependencies on objects mentioned in the
    1126             :      * expression (eg, functions, as well as any columns used).
    1127             :      */
    1128       14922 :     if (whenRtable != NIL)
    1129         110 :         recordDependencyOnExpr(&myself, whenClause, whenRtable,
    1130             :                                DEPENDENCY_NORMAL);
    1131             : 
    1132             :     /* Post creation hook for new trigger */
    1133       14922 :     InvokeObjectPostCreateHookArg(TriggerRelationId, trigoid, 0,
    1134             :                                   isInternal);
    1135             : 
    1136             :     /*
    1137             :      * Lastly, create the trigger on child relations, if needed.
    1138             :      */
    1139       14922 :     if (partition_recurse)
    1140             :     {
    1141         398 :         PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(rel, true);
    1142             :         int         i;
    1143             :         MemoryContext oldcxt,
    1144             :                     perChildCxt;
    1145             : 
    1146         398 :         perChildCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(CurrentMemoryContext,
    1147             :                                             "part trig clone",
    1148             :                                             ALLOCSET_SMALL_SIZES);
    1149             : 
    1150             :         /*
    1151             :          * We don't currently expect to be called with a valid indexOid.  If
    1152             :          * that ever changes then we'll need to write code here to find the
    1153             :          * corresponding child index.
    1154             :          */
    1155             :         Assert(!OidIsValid(indexOid));
    1156             : 
    1157         398 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(perChildCxt);
    1158             : 
    1159             :         /* Iterate to create the trigger on each existing partition */
    1160        1088 :         for (i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1161             :         {
    1162             :             CreateTrigStmt *childStmt;
    1163             :             Relation    childTbl;
    1164             :             Node       *qual;
    1165             : 
    1166         696 :             childTbl = table_open(partdesc->oids[i], ShareRowExclusiveLock);
    1167             : 
    1168             :             /*
    1169             :              * Initialize our fabricated parse node by copying the original
    1170             :              * one, then resetting fields that we pass separately.
    1171             :              */
    1172         696 :             childStmt = (CreateTrigStmt *) copyObject(stmt);
    1173         696 :             childStmt->funcname = NIL;
    1174         696 :             childStmt->whenClause = NULL;
    1175             : 
    1176             :             /* If there is a WHEN clause, create a modified copy of it */
    1177         696 :             qual = copyObject(whenClause);
    1178             :             qual = (Node *)
    1179         696 :                 map_partition_varattnos((List *) qual, PRS2_OLD_VARNO,
    1180             :                                         childTbl, rel);
    1181             :             qual = (Node *)
    1182         696 :                 map_partition_varattnos((List *) qual, PRS2_NEW_VARNO,
    1183             :                                         childTbl, rel);
    1184             : 
    1185         696 :             CreateTriggerFiringOn(childStmt, queryString,
    1186         696 :                                   partdesc->oids[i], refRelOid,
    1187             :                                   InvalidOid, InvalidOid,
    1188             :                                   funcoid, trigoid, qual,
    1189             :                                   isInternal, true, trigger_fires_when);
    1190             : 
    1191         690 :             table_close(childTbl, NoLock);
    1192             : 
    1193         690 :             MemoryContextReset(perChildCxt);
    1194             :         }
    1195             : 
    1196         392 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    1197         392 :         MemoryContextDelete(perChildCxt);
    1198             :     }
    1199             : 
    1200             :     /* Keep lock on target rel until end of xact */
    1201       14916 :     table_close(rel, NoLock);
    1202             : 
    1203       14916 :     return myself;
    1204             : }
    1205             : 
    1206             : /*
    1207             :  * TriggerSetParentTrigger
    1208             :  *      Set a partition's trigger as child of its parent trigger,
    1209             :  *      or remove the linkage if parentTrigId is InvalidOid.
    1210             :  *
    1211             :  * This updates the constraint's pg_trigger row to show it as inherited, and
    1212             :  * adds PARTITION dependencies to prevent the trigger from being deleted
    1213             :  * on its own.  Alternatively, reverse that.
    1214             :  */
    1215             : void
    1216         288 : TriggerSetParentTrigger(Relation trigRel,
    1217             :                         Oid childTrigId,
    1218             :                         Oid parentTrigId,
    1219             :                         Oid childTableId)
    1220             : {
    1221             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1222             :     ScanKeyData skey[1];
    1223             :     Form_pg_trigger trigForm;
    1224             :     HeapTuple   tuple,
    1225             :                 newtup;
    1226             :     ObjectAddress depender;
    1227             :     ObjectAddress referenced;
    1228             : 
    1229             :     /*
    1230             :      * Find the trigger to delete.
    1231             :      */
    1232         288 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1233             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_oid,
    1234             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1235             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(childTrigId));
    1236             : 
    1237         288 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(trigRel, TriggerOidIndexId, true,
    1238             :                                 NULL, 1, skey);
    1239             : 
    1240         288 :     tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1241         288 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1242           0 :         elog(ERROR, "could not find tuple for trigger %u", childTrigId);
    1243         288 :     newtup = heap_copytuple(tuple);
    1244         288 :     trigForm = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    1245         288 :     if (OidIsValid(parentTrigId))
    1246             :     {
    1247             :         /* don't allow setting parent for a constraint that already has one */
    1248         156 :         if (OidIsValid(trigForm->tgparentid))
    1249           0 :             elog(ERROR, "trigger %u already has a parent trigger",
    1250             :                  childTrigId);
    1251             : 
    1252         156 :         trigForm->tgparentid = parentTrigId;
    1253             : 
    1254         156 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(trigRel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
    1255             : 
    1256         156 :         ObjectAddressSet(depender, TriggerRelationId, childTrigId);
    1257             : 
    1258         156 :         ObjectAddressSet(referenced, TriggerRelationId, parentTrigId);
    1259         156 :         recordDependencyOn(&depender, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1260             : 
    1261         156 :         ObjectAddressSet(referenced, RelationRelationId, childTableId);
    1262         156 :         recordDependencyOn(&depender, &referenced, DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1263             :     }
    1264             :     else
    1265             :     {
    1266         132 :         trigForm->tgparentid = InvalidOid;
    1267             : 
    1268         132 :         CatalogTupleUpdate(trigRel, &tuple->t_self, newtup);
    1269             : 
    1270         132 :         deleteDependencyRecordsForClass(TriggerRelationId, childTrigId,
    1271             :                                         TriggerRelationId,
    1272             :                                         DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_PRI);
    1273         132 :         deleteDependencyRecordsForClass(TriggerRelationId, childTrigId,
    1274             :                                         RelationRelationId,
    1275             :                                         DEPENDENCY_PARTITION_SEC);
    1276             :     }
    1277             : 
    1278         288 :     heap_freetuple(newtup);
    1279         288 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1280         288 : }
    1281             : 
    1282             : 
    1283             : /*
    1284             :  * Guts of trigger deletion.
    1285             :  */
    1286             : void
    1287       12668 : RemoveTriggerById(Oid trigOid)
    1288             : {
    1289             :     Relation    tgrel;
    1290             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1291             :     ScanKeyData skey[1];
    1292             :     HeapTuple   tup;
    1293             :     Oid         relid;
    1294             :     Relation    rel;
    1295             : 
    1296       12668 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1297             : 
    1298             :     /*
    1299             :      * Find the trigger to delete.
    1300             :      */
    1301       12668 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1302             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_oid,
    1303             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1304             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(trigOid));
    1305             : 
    1306       12668 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerOidIndexId, true,
    1307             :                                 NULL, 1, skey);
    1308             : 
    1309       12668 :     tup = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1310       12668 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
    1311           0 :         elog(ERROR, "could not find tuple for trigger %u", trigOid);
    1312             : 
    1313             :     /*
    1314             :      * Open and exclusive-lock the relation the trigger belongs to.
    1315             :      */
    1316       12668 :     relid = ((Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tup))->tgrelid;
    1317             : 
    1318       12668 :     rel = table_open(relid, AccessExclusiveLock);
    1319             : 
    1320       12668 :     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION &&
    1321        2096 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_VIEW &&
    1322        1966 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE &&
    1323        1874 :         rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1324           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1325             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    1326             :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
    1327             :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel)),
    1328             :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(rel->rd_rel->relkind)));
    1329             : 
    1330       12668 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemRelation(rel))
    1331           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1332             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1333             :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
    1334             :                         RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
    1335             : 
    1336             :     /*
    1337             :      * Delete the pg_trigger tuple.
    1338             :      */
    1339       12668 :     CatalogTupleDelete(tgrel, &tup->t_self);
    1340             : 
    1341       12668 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1342       12668 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1343             : 
    1344             :     /*
    1345             :      * We do not bother to try to determine whether any other triggers remain,
    1346             :      * which would be needed in order to decide whether it's safe to clear the
    1347             :      * relation's relhastriggers.  (In any case, there might be a concurrent
    1348             :      * process adding new triggers.)  Instead, just force a relcache inval to
    1349             :      * make other backends (and this one too!) rebuild their relcache entries.
    1350             :      * There's no great harm in leaving relhastriggers true even if there are
    1351             :      * no triggers left.
    1352             :      */
    1353       12668 :     CacheInvalidateRelcache(rel);
    1354             : 
    1355             :     /* Keep lock on trigger's rel until end of xact */
    1356       12668 :     table_close(rel, NoLock);
    1357       12668 : }
    1358             : 
    1359             : /*
    1360             :  * get_trigger_oid - Look up a trigger by name to find its OID.
    1361             :  *
    1362             :  * If missing_ok is false, throw an error if trigger not found.  If
    1363             :  * true, just return InvalidOid.
    1364             :  */
    1365             : Oid
    1366         752 : get_trigger_oid(Oid relid, const char *trigname, bool missing_ok)
    1367             : {
    1368             :     Relation    tgrel;
    1369             :     ScanKeyData skey[2];
    1370             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1371             :     HeapTuple   tup;
    1372             :     Oid         oid;
    1373             : 
    1374             :     /*
    1375             :      * Find the trigger, verify permissions, set up object address
    1376             :      */
    1377         752 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    1378             : 
    1379         752 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    1380             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1381             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1382             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1383         752 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey[1],
    1384             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1385             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1386             :                 CStringGetDatum(trigname));
    1387             : 
    1388         752 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1389             :                                 NULL, 2, skey);
    1390             : 
    1391         752 :     tup = systable_getnext(tgscan);
    1392             : 
    1393         752 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
    1394             :     {
    1395          30 :         if (!missing_ok)
    1396          24 :             ereport(ERROR,
    1397             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1398             :                      errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1399             :                             trigname, get_rel_name(relid))));
    1400           6 :         oid = InvalidOid;
    1401             :     }
    1402             :     else
    1403             :     {
    1404         722 :         oid = ((Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tup))->oid;
    1405             :     }
    1406             : 
    1407         728 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1408         728 :     table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    1409         728 :     return oid;
    1410             : }
    1411             : 
    1412             : /*
    1413             :  * Perform permissions and integrity checks before acquiring a relation lock.
    1414             :  */
    1415             : static void
    1416          42 : RangeVarCallbackForRenameTrigger(const RangeVar *rv, Oid relid, Oid oldrelid,
    1417             :                                  void *arg)
    1418             : {
    1419             :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1420             :     Form_pg_class form;
    1421             : 
    1422          42 :     tuple = SearchSysCache1(RELOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1423          42 :     if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tuple))
    1424           0 :         return;                 /* concurrently dropped */
    1425          42 :     form = (Form_pg_class) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1426             : 
    1427             :     /* only tables and views can have triggers */
    1428          42 :     if (form->relkind != RELKIND_RELATION && form->relkind != RELKIND_VIEW &&
    1429          24 :         form->relkind != RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE &&
    1430          24 :         form->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1431           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1432             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    1433             :                  errmsg("relation \"%s\" cannot have triggers",
    1434             :                         rv->relname),
    1435             :                  errdetail_relkind_not_supported(form->relkind)));
    1436             : 
    1437             :     /* you must own the table to rename one of its triggers */
    1438          42 :     if (!object_ownercheck(RelationRelationId, relid, GetUserId()))
    1439           0 :         aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, get_relkind_objtype(get_rel_relkind(relid)), rv->relname);
    1440          42 :     if (!allowSystemTableMods && IsSystemClass(relid, form))
    1441           2 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1442             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1443             :                  errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system catalog",
    1444             :                         rv->relname)));
    1445             : 
    1446          40 :     ReleaseSysCache(tuple);
    1447             : }
    1448             : 
    1449             : /*
    1450             :  *      renametrig      - changes the name of a trigger on a relation
    1451             :  *
    1452             :  *      trigger name is changed in trigger catalog.
    1453             :  *      No record of the previous name is kept.
    1454             :  *
    1455             :  *      get proper relrelation from relation catalog (if not arg)
    1456             :  *      scan trigger catalog
    1457             :  *              for name conflict (within rel)
    1458             :  *              for original trigger (if not arg)
    1459             :  *      modify tgname in trigger tuple
    1460             :  *      update row in catalog
    1461             :  */
    1462             : ObjectAddress
    1463          40 : renametrig(RenameStmt *stmt)
    1464             : {
    1465             :     Oid         tgoid;
    1466             :     Relation    targetrel;
    1467             :     Relation    tgrel;
    1468             :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1469             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1470             :     ScanKeyData key[2];
    1471             :     Oid         relid;
    1472             :     ObjectAddress address;
    1473             : 
    1474             :     /*
    1475             :      * Look up name, check permissions, and acquire lock (which we will NOT
    1476             :      * release until end of transaction).
    1477             :      */
    1478          40 :     relid = RangeVarGetRelidExtended(stmt->relation, AccessExclusiveLock,
    1479             :                                      0,
    1480             :                                      RangeVarCallbackForRenameTrigger,
    1481             :                                      NULL);
    1482             : 
    1483             :     /* Have lock already, so just need to build relcache entry. */
    1484          38 :     targetrel = relation_open(relid, NoLock);
    1485             : 
    1486             :     /*
    1487             :      * On partitioned tables, this operation recurses to partitions.  Lock all
    1488             :      * tables upfront.
    1489             :      */
    1490          38 :     if (targetrel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1491          24 :         (void) find_all_inheritors(relid, AccessExclusiveLock, NULL);
    1492             : 
    1493          38 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1494             : 
    1495             :     /*
    1496             :      * Search for the trigger to modify.
    1497             :      */
    1498          38 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[0],
    1499             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1500             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1501             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(relid));
    1502          38 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[1],
    1503             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1504             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1505          38 :                 PointerGetDatum(stmt->subname));
    1506          38 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1507             :                                 NULL, 2, key);
    1508          38 :     if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1509             :     {
    1510             :         Form_pg_trigger trigform;
    1511             : 
    1512          38 :         trigform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1513          38 :         tgoid = trigform->oid;
    1514             : 
    1515             :         /*
    1516             :          * If the trigger descends from a trigger on a parent partitioned
    1517             :          * table, reject the rename.  We don't allow a trigger in a partition
    1518             :          * to differ in name from that of its parent: that would lead to an
    1519             :          * inconsistency that pg_dump would not reproduce.
    1520             :          */
    1521          38 :         if (OidIsValid(trigform->tgparentid))
    1522           6 :             ereport(ERROR,
    1523             :                     errmsg("cannot rename trigger \"%s\" on table \"%s\"",
    1524             :                            stmt->subname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel)),
    1525             :                     errhint("Rename the trigger on the partitioned table \"%s\" instead.",
    1526             :                             get_rel_name(get_partition_parent(relid, false))));
    1527             : 
    1528             : 
    1529             :         /* Rename the trigger on this relation ... */
    1530          32 :         renametrig_internal(tgrel, targetrel, tuple, stmt->newname,
    1531          32 :                             stmt->subname);
    1532             : 
    1533             :         /* ... and if it is partitioned, recurse to its partitions */
    1534          32 :         if (targetrel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1535             :         {
    1536          18 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(targetrel, true);
    1537             : 
    1538          30 :             for (int i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1539             :             {
    1540          18 :                 Oid         partitionId = partdesc->oids[i];
    1541             : 
    1542          18 :                 renametrig_partition(tgrel, partitionId, trigform->oid,
    1543          18 :                                      stmt->newname, stmt->subname);
    1544             :             }
    1545             :         }
    1546             :     }
    1547             :     else
    1548             :     {
    1549           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1550             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1551             :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1552             :                         stmt->subname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel))));
    1553             :     }
    1554             : 
    1555          26 :     ObjectAddressSet(address, TriggerRelationId, tgoid);
    1556             : 
    1557          26 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1558             : 
    1559          26 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1560             : 
    1561             :     /*
    1562             :      * Close rel, but keep exclusive lock!
    1563             :      */
    1564          26 :     relation_close(targetrel, NoLock);
    1565             : 
    1566          26 :     return address;
    1567             : }
    1568             : 
    1569             : /*
    1570             :  * Subroutine for renametrig -- perform the actual work of renaming one
    1571             :  * trigger on one table.
    1572             :  *
    1573             :  * If the trigger has a name different from the expected one, raise a
    1574             :  * NOTICE about it.
    1575             :  */
    1576             : static void
    1577          56 : renametrig_internal(Relation tgrel, Relation targetrel, HeapTuple trigtup,
    1578             :                     const char *newname, const char *expected_name)
    1579             : {
    1580             :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1581             :     Form_pg_trigger tgform;
    1582             :     ScanKeyData key[2];
    1583             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1584             : 
    1585             :     /* If the trigger already has the new name, nothing to do. */
    1586          56 :     tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(trigtup);
    1587          56 :     if (strcmp(NameStr(tgform->tgname), newname) == 0)
    1588           0 :         return;
    1589             : 
    1590             :     /*
    1591             :      * Before actually trying the rename, search for triggers with the same
    1592             :      * name.  The update would fail with an ugly message in that case, and it
    1593             :      * is better to throw a nicer error.
    1594             :      */
    1595          56 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[0],
    1596             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1597             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1598             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(targetrel)));
    1599          56 :     ScanKeyInit(&key[1],
    1600             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1601             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1602             :                 PointerGetDatum(newname));
    1603          56 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1604             :                                 NULL, 2, key);
    1605          56 :     if (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1606           6 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1607             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DUPLICATE_OBJECT),
    1608             :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for relation \"%s\" already exists",
    1609             :                         newname, RelationGetRelationName(targetrel))));
    1610          50 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1611             : 
    1612             :     /*
    1613             :      * The target name is free; update the existing pg_trigger tuple with it.
    1614             :      */
    1615          50 :     tuple = heap_copytuple(trigtup);    /* need a modifiable copy */
    1616          50 :     tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1617             : 
    1618             :     /*
    1619             :      * If the trigger has a name different from what we expected, let the user
    1620             :      * know. (We can proceed anyway, since we must have reached here following
    1621             :      * a tgparentid link.)
    1622             :      */
    1623          50 :     if (strcmp(NameStr(tgform->tgname), expected_name) != 0)
    1624           0 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    1625             :                 errmsg("renamed trigger \"%s\" on relation \"%s\"",
    1626             :                        NameStr(tgform->tgname),
    1627             :                        RelationGetRelationName(targetrel)));
    1628             : 
    1629          50 :     namestrcpy(&tgform->tgname, newname);
    1630             : 
    1631          50 :     CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &tuple->t_self, tuple);
    1632             : 
    1633          50 :     InvokeObjectPostAlterHook(TriggerRelationId, tgform->oid, 0);
    1634             : 
    1635             :     /*
    1636             :      * Invalidate relation's relcache entry so that other backends (and this
    1637             :      * one too!) are sent SI message to make them rebuild relcache entries.
    1638             :      * (Ideally this should happen automatically...)
    1639             :      */
    1640          50 :     CacheInvalidateRelcache(targetrel);
    1641             : }
    1642             : 
    1643             : /*
    1644             :  * Subroutine for renametrig -- Helper for recursing to partitions when
    1645             :  * renaming triggers on a partitioned table.
    1646             :  */
    1647             : static void
    1648          30 : renametrig_partition(Relation tgrel, Oid partitionId, Oid parentTriggerOid,
    1649             :                      const char *newname, const char *expected_name)
    1650             : {
    1651             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1652             :     ScanKeyData key;
    1653             :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1654             : 
    1655             :     /*
    1656             :      * Given a relation and the OID of a trigger on parent relation, find the
    1657             :      * corresponding trigger in the child and rename that trigger to the given
    1658             :      * name.
    1659             :      */
    1660          30 :     ScanKeyInit(&key,
    1661             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1662             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1663             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(partitionId));
    1664          30 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1665             :                                 NULL, 1, &key);
    1666          48 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1667             :     {
    1668          42 :         Form_pg_trigger tgform = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1669             :         Relation    partitionRel;
    1670             : 
    1671          42 :         if (tgform->tgparentid != parentTriggerOid)
    1672          18 :             continue;           /* not our trigger */
    1673             : 
    1674          24 :         partitionRel = table_open(partitionId, NoLock);
    1675             : 
    1676             :         /* Rename the trigger on this partition */
    1677          24 :         renametrig_internal(tgrel, partitionRel, tuple, newname, expected_name);
    1678             : 
    1679             :         /* And if this relation is partitioned, recurse to its partitions */
    1680          18 :         if (partitionRel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    1681             :         {
    1682           6 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(partitionRel,
    1683             :                                                               true);
    1684             : 
    1685          18 :             for (int i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1686             :             {
    1687          12 :                 Oid         partoid = partdesc->oids[i];
    1688             : 
    1689          12 :                 renametrig_partition(tgrel, partoid, tgform->oid, newname,
    1690          12 :                                      NameStr(tgform->tgname));
    1691             :             }
    1692             :         }
    1693          18 :         table_close(partitionRel, NoLock);
    1694             : 
    1695             :         /* There should be at most one matching tuple */
    1696          18 :         break;
    1697             :     }
    1698          24 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1699          24 : }
    1700             : 
    1701             : /*
    1702             :  * EnableDisableTrigger()
    1703             :  *
    1704             :  *  Called by ALTER TABLE ENABLE/DISABLE [ REPLICA | ALWAYS ] TRIGGER
    1705             :  *  to change 'tgenabled' field for the specified trigger(s)
    1706             :  *
    1707             :  * rel: relation to process (caller must hold suitable lock on it)
    1708             :  * tgname: name of trigger to process, or NULL to scan all triggers
    1709             :  * tgparent: if not zero, process only triggers with this tgparentid
    1710             :  * fires_when: new value for tgenabled field. In addition to generic
    1711             :  *             enablement/disablement, this also defines when the trigger
    1712             :  *             should be fired in session replication roles.
    1713             :  * skip_system: if true, skip "system" triggers (constraint triggers)
    1714             :  * recurse: if true, recurse to partitions
    1715             :  *
    1716             :  * Caller should have checked permissions for the table; here we also
    1717             :  * enforce that superuser privilege is required to alter the state of
    1718             :  * system triggers
    1719             :  */
    1720             : void
    1721         450 : EnableDisableTrigger(Relation rel, const char *tgname, Oid tgparent,
    1722             :                      char fires_when, bool skip_system, bool recurse,
    1723             :                      LOCKMODE lockmode)
    1724             : {
    1725             :     Relation    tgrel;
    1726             :     int         nkeys;
    1727             :     ScanKeyData keys[2];
    1728             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1729             :     HeapTuple   tuple;
    1730             :     bool        found;
    1731             :     bool        changed;
    1732             : 
    1733             :     /* Scan the relevant entries in pg_triggers */
    1734         450 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
    1735             : 
    1736         450 :     ScanKeyInit(&keys[0],
    1737             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1738             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1739             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(rel)));
    1740         450 :     if (tgname)
    1741             :     {
    1742         316 :         ScanKeyInit(&keys[1],
    1743             :                     Anum_pg_trigger_tgname,
    1744             :                     BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    1745             :                     CStringGetDatum(tgname));
    1746         316 :         nkeys = 2;
    1747             :     }
    1748             :     else
    1749         134 :         nkeys = 1;
    1750             : 
    1751         450 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1752             :                                 NULL, nkeys, keys);
    1753             : 
    1754         450 :     found = changed = false;
    1755             : 
    1756        1128 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1757             :     {
    1758         678 :         Form_pg_trigger oldtrig = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    1759             : 
    1760         678 :         if (OidIsValid(tgparent) && tgparent != oldtrig->tgparentid)
    1761         156 :             continue;
    1762             : 
    1763         522 :         if (oldtrig->tgisinternal)
    1764             :         {
    1765             :             /* system trigger ... ok to process? */
    1766          60 :             if (skip_system)
    1767          12 :                 continue;
    1768          48 :             if (!superuser())
    1769           0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    1770             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    1771             :                          errmsg("permission denied: \"%s\" is a system trigger",
    1772             :                                 NameStr(oldtrig->tgname))));
    1773             :         }
    1774             : 
    1775         510 :         found = true;
    1776             : 
    1777         510 :         if (oldtrig->tgenabled != fires_when)
    1778             :         {
    1779             :             /* need to change this one ... make a copy to scribble on */
    1780         480 :             HeapTuple   newtup = heap_copytuple(tuple);
    1781         480 :             Form_pg_trigger newtrig = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(newtup);
    1782             : 
    1783         480 :             newtrig->tgenabled = fires_when;
    1784             : 
    1785         480 :             CatalogTupleUpdate(tgrel, &newtup->t_self, newtup);
    1786             : 
    1787         480 :             heap_freetuple(newtup);
    1788             : 
    1789         480 :             changed = true;
    1790             :         }
    1791             : 
    1792             :         /*
    1793             :          * When altering FOR EACH ROW triggers on a partitioned table, do the
    1794             :          * same on the partitions as well, unless ONLY is specified.
    1795             :          *
    1796             :          * Note that we recurse even if we didn't change the trigger above,
    1797             :          * because the partitions' copy of the trigger may have a different
    1798             :          * value of tgenabled than the parent's trigger and thus might need to
    1799             :          * be changed.
    1800             :          */
    1801         510 :         if (recurse &&
    1802         482 :             rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE &&
    1803          86 :             (TRIGGER_FOR_ROW(oldtrig->tgtype)))
    1804             :         {
    1805          74 :             PartitionDesc partdesc = RelationGetPartitionDesc(rel, true);
    1806             :             int         i;
    1807             : 
    1808         184 :             for (i = 0; i < partdesc->nparts; i++)
    1809             :             {
    1810             :                 Relation    part;
    1811             : 
    1812         110 :                 part = relation_open(partdesc->oids[i], lockmode);
    1813             :                 /* Match on child triggers' tgparentid, not their name */
    1814         110 :                 EnableDisableTrigger(part, NULL, oldtrig->oid,
    1815             :                                      fires_when, skip_system, recurse,
    1816             :                                      lockmode);
    1817         110 :                 table_close(part, NoLock);  /* keep lock till commit */
    1818             :             }
    1819             :         }
    1820             : 
    1821         510 :         InvokeObjectPostAlterHook(TriggerRelationId,
    1822             :                                   oldtrig->oid, 0);
    1823             :     }
    1824             : 
    1825         450 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1826             : 
    1827         450 :     table_close(tgrel, RowExclusiveLock);
    1828             : 
    1829         450 :     if (tgname && !found)
    1830           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1831             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    1832             :                  errmsg("trigger \"%s\" for table \"%s\" does not exist",
    1833             :                         tgname, RelationGetRelationName(rel))));
    1834             : 
    1835             :     /*
    1836             :      * If we changed anything, broadcast a SI inval message to force each
    1837             :      * backend (including our own!) to rebuild relation's relcache entry.
    1838             :      * Otherwise they will fail to apply the change promptly.
    1839             :      */
    1840         450 :     if (changed)
    1841         432 :         CacheInvalidateRelcache(rel);
    1842         450 : }
    1843             : 
    1844             : 
    1845             : /*
    1846             :  * Build trigger data to attach to the given relcache entry.
    1847             :  *
    1848             :  * Note that trigger data attached to a relcache entry must be stored in
    1849             :  * CacheMemoryContext to ensure it survives as long as the relcache entry.
    1850             :  * But we should be running in a less long-lived working context.  To avoid
    1851             :  * leaking cache memory if this routine fails partway through, we build a
    1852             :  * temporary TriggerDesc in working memory and then copy the completed
    1853             :  * structure into cache memory.
    1854             :  */
    1855             : void
    1856       56310 : RelationBuildTriggers(Relation relation)
    1857             : {
    1858             :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    1859             :     int         numtrigs;
    1860             :     int         maxtrigs;
    1861             :     Trigger    *triggers;
    1862             :     Relation    tgrel;
    1863             :     ScanKeyData skey;
    1864             :     SysScanDesc tgscan;
    1865             :     HeapTuple   htup;
    1866             :     MemoryContext oldContext;
    1867             :     int         i;
    1868             : 
    1869             :     /*
    1870             :      * Allocate a working array to hold the triggers (the array is extended if
    1871             :      * necessary)
    1872             :      */
    1873       56310 :     maxtrigs = 16;
    1874       56310 :     triggers = (Trigger *) palloc(maxtrigs * sizeof(Trigger));
    1875       56310 :     numtrigs = 0;
    1876             : 
    1877             :     /*
    1878             :      * Note: since we scan the triggers using TriggerRelidNameIndexId, we will
    1879             :      * be reading the triggers in name order, except possibly during
    1880             :      * emergency-recovery operations (ie, IgnoreSystemIndexes). This in turn
    1881             :      * ensures that triggers will be fired in name order.
    1882             :      */
    1883       56310 :     ScanKeyInit(&skey,
    1884             :                 Anum_pg_trigger_tgrelid,
    1885             :                 BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    1886             :                 ObjectIdGetDatum(RelationGetRelid(relation)));
    1887             : 
    1888       56310 :     tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    1889       56310 :     tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerRelidNameIndexId, true,
    1890             :                                 NULL, 1, &skey);
    1891             : 
    1892      151100 :     while (HeapTupleIsValid(htup = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    1893             :     {
    1894       94790 :         Form_pg_trigger pg_trigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(htup);
    1895             :         Trigger    *build;
    1896             :         Datum       datum;
    1897             :         bool        isnull;
    1898             : 
    1899       94790 :         if (numtrigs >= maxtrigs)
    1900             :         {
    1901          48 :             maxtrigs *= 2;
    1902          48 :             triggers = (Trigger *) repalloc(triggers, maxtrigs * sizeof(Trigger));
    1903             :         }
    1904       94790 :         build = &(triggers[numtrigs]);
    1905             : 
    1906       94790 :         build->tgoid = pg_trigger->oid;
    1907       94790 :         build->tgname = DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout,
    1908             :                                                             NameGetDatum(&pg_trigger->tgname)));
    1909       94790 :         build->tgfoid = pg_trigger->tgfoid;
    1910       94790 :         build->tgtype = pg_trigger->tgtype;
    1911       94790 :         build->tgenabled = pg_trigger->tgenabled;
    1912       94790 :         build->tgisinternal = pg_trigger->tgisinternal;
    1913       94790 :         build->tgisclone = OidIsValid(pg_trigger->tgparentid);
    1914       94790 :         build->tgconstrrelid = pg_trigger->tgconstrrelid;
    1915       94790 :         build->tgconstrindid = pg_trigger->tgconstrindid;
    1916       94790 :         build->tgconstraint = pg_trigger->tgconstraint;
    1917       94790 :         build->tgdeferrable = pg_trigger->tgdeferrable;
    1918       94790 :         build->tginitdeferred = pg_trigger->tginitdeferred;
    1919       94790 :         build->tgnargs = pg_trigger->tgnargs;
    1920             :         /* tgattr is first var-width field, so OK to access directly */
    1921       94790 :         build->tgnattr = pg_trigger->tgattr.dim1;
    1922       94790 :         if (build->tgnattr > 0)
    1923             :         {
    1924         500 :             build->tgattr = (int16 *) palloc(build->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    1925         500 :             memcpy(build->tgattr, &(pg_trigger->tgattr.values),
    1926         500 :                    build->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    1927             :         }
    1928             :         else
    1929       94290 :             build->tgattr = NULL;
    1930       94790 :         if (build->tgnargs > 0)
    1931             :         {
    1932             :             bytea      *val;
    1933             :             char       *p;
    1934             : 
    1935        3214 :             val = DatumGetByteaPP(fastgetattr(htup,
    1936             :                                               Anum_pg_trigger_tgargs,
    1937             :                                               tgrel->rd_att, &isnull));
    1938        3214 :             if (isnull)
    1939           0 :                 elog(ERROR, "tgargs is null in trigger for relation \"%s\"",
    1940             :                      RelationGetRelationName(relation));
    1941        3214 :             p = (char *) VARDATA_ANY(val);
    1942        3214 :             build->tgargs = (char **) palloc(build->tgnargs * sizeof(char *));
    1943        7138 :             for (i = 0; i < build->tgnargs; i++)
    1944             :             {
    1945        3924 :                 build->tgargs[i] = pstrdup(p);
    1946        3924 :                 p += strlen(p) + 1;
    1947             :             }
    1948             :         }
    1949             :         else
    1950       91576 :             build->tgargs = NULL;
    1951             : 
    1952       94790 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgoldtable,
    1953             :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1954       94790 :         if (!isnull)
    1955         734 :             build->tgoldtable =
    1956         734 :                 DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout, datum));
    1957             :         else
    1958       94056 :             build->tgoldtable = NULL;
    1959             : 
    1960       94790 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgnewtable,
    1961             :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1962       94790 :         if (!isnull)
    1963        1036 :             build->tgnewtable =
    1964        1036 :                 DatumGetCString(DirectFunctionCall1(nameout, datum));
    1965             :         else
    1966       93754 :             build->tgnewtable = NULL;
    1967             : 
    1968       94790 :         datum = fastgetattr(htup, Anum_pg_trigger_tgqual,
    1969             :                             tgrel->rd_att, &isnull);
    1970       94790 :         if (!isnull)
    1971         746 :             build->tgqual = TextDatumGetCString(datum);
    1972             :         else
    1973       94044 :             build->tgqual = NULL;
    1974             : 
    1975       94790 :         numtrigs++;
    1976             :     }
    1977             : 
    1978       56310 :     systable_endscan(tgscan);
    1979       56310 :     table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    1980             : 
    1981             :     /* There might not be any triggers */
    1982       56310 :     if (numtrigs == 0)
    1983             :     {
    1984       13420 :         pfree(triggers);
    1985       13420 :         return;
    1986             :     }
    1987             : 
    1988             :     /* Build trigdesc */
    1989       42890 :     trigdesc = (TriggerDesc *) palloc0(sizeof(TriggerDesc));
    1990       42890 :     trigdesc->triggers = triggers;
    1991       42890 :     trigdesc->numtriggers = numtrigs;
    1992      137680 :     for (i = 0; i < numtrigs; i++)
    1993       94790 :         SetTriggerFlags(trigdesc, &(triggers[i]));
    1994             : 
    1995             :     /* Copy completed trigdesc into cache storage */
    1996       42890 :     oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CacheMemoryContext);
    1997       42890 :     relation->trigdesc = CopyTriggerDesc(trigdesc);
    1998       42890 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    1999             : 
    2000             :     /* Release working memory */
    2001       42890 :     FreeTriggerDesc(trigdesc);
    2002             : }
    2003             : 
    2004             : /*
    2005             :  * Update the TriggerDesc's hint flags to include the specified trigger
    2006             :  */
    2007             : static void
    2008       94790 : SetTriggerFlags(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Trigger *trigger)
    2009             : {
    2010       94790 :     int16       tgtype = trigger->tgtype;
    2011             : 
    2012       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_before_row |=
    2013       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2014             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2015       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row |=
    2016       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2017             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2018       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_instead_row |=
    2019       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2020             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2021       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_before_statement |=
    2022       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2023             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2024       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_after_statement |=
    2025       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2026             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT);
    2027       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_update_before_row |=
    2028       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2029             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2030       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_update_after_row |=
    2031       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2032             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2033       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_update_instead_row |=
    2034       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2035             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2036       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_update_before_statement |=
    2037       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2038             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2039       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_update_after_statement |=
    2040       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2041             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE);
    2042       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_before_row |=
    2043       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2044             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2045       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row |=
    2046       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2047             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2048       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_instead_row |=
    2049       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2050             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2051       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_before_statement |=
    2052       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2053             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2054       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_after_statement |=
    2055       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2056             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE);
    2057             :     /* there are no row-level truncate triggers */
    2058       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_truncate_before_statement |=
    2059       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2060             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE, TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE);
    2061       94790 :     trigdesc->trig_truncate_after_statement |=
    2062       94790 :         TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(tgtype, TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2063             :                              TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER, TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE);
    2064             : 
    2065      189580 :     trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table |=
    2066      127824 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_INSERT(tgtype) &&
    2067       33034 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgnewtable));
    2068      189580 :     trigdesc->trig_update_old_table |=
    2069      137472 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) &&
    2070       42682 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgoldtable));
    2071      189580 :     trigdesc->trig_update_new_table |=
    2072      137472 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(tgtype) &&
    2073       42682 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgnewtable));
    2074      189580 :     trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table |=
    2075      120162 :         (TRIGGER_FOR_DELETE(tgtype) &&
    2076       25372 :          TRIGGER_USES_TRANSITION_TABLE(trigger->tgoldtable));
    2077       94790 : }
    2078             : 
    2079             : /*
    2080             :  * Copy a TriggerDesc data structure.
    2081             :  *
    2082             :  * The copy is allocated in the current memory context.
    2083             :  */
    2084             : TriggerDesc *
    2085      479296 : CopyTriggerDesc(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2086             : {
    2087             :     TriggerDesc *newdesc;
    2088             :     Trigger    *trigger;
    2089             :     int         i;
    2090             : 
    2091      479296 :     if (trigdesc == NULL || trigdesc->numtriggers <= 0)
    2092      419176 :         return NULL;
    2093             : 
    2094       60120 :     newdesc = (TriggerDesc *) palloc(sizeof(TriggerDesc));
    2095       60120 :     memcpy(newdesc, trigdesc, sizeof(TriggerDesc));
    2096             : 
    2097       60120 :     trigger = (Trigger *) palloc(trigdesc->numtriggers * sizeof(Trigger));
    2098       60120 :     memcpy(trigger, trigdesc->triggers,
    2099       60120 :            trigdesc->numtriggers * sizeof(Trigger));
    2100       60120 :     newdesc->triggers = trigger;
    2101             : 
    2102      202690 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2103             :     {
    2104      142570 :         trigger->tgname = pstrdup(trigger->tgname);
    2105      142570 :         if (trigger->tgnattr > 0)
    2106             :         {
    2107             :             int16      *newattr;
    2108             : 
    2109         980 :             newattr = (int16 *) palloc(trigger->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    2110         980 :             memcpy(newattr, trigger->tgattr,
    2111         980 :                    trigger->tgnattr * sizeof(int16));
    2112         980 :             trigger->tgattr = newattr;
    2113             :         }
    2114      142570 :         if (trigger->tgnargs > 0)
    2115             :         {
    2116             :             char      **newargs;
    2117             :             int16       j;
    2118             : 
    2119        9784 :             newargs = (char **) palloc(trigger->tgnargs * sizeof(char *));
    2120       21828 :             for (j = 0; j < trigger->tgnargs; j++)
    2121       12044 :                 newargs[j] = pstrdup(trigger->tgargs[j]);
    2122        9784 :             trigger->tgargs = newargs;
    2123             :         }
    2124      142570 :         if (trigger->tgqual)
    2125        1220 :             trigger->tgqual = pstrdup(trigger->tgqual);
    2126      142570 :         if (trigger->tgoldtable)
    2127        1862 :             trigger->tgoldtable = pstrdup(trigger->tgoldtable);
    2128      142570 :         if (trigger->tgnewtable)
    2129        2212 :             trigger->tgnewtable = pstrdup(trigger->tgnewtable);
    2130      142570 :         trigger++;
    2131             :     }
    2132             : 
    2133       60120 :     return newdesc;
    2134             : }
    2135             : 
    2136             : /*
    2137             :  * Free a TriggerDesc data structure.
    2138             :  */
    2139             : void
    2140     1026146 : FreeTriggerDesc(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2141             : {
    2142             :     Trigger    *trigger;
    2143             :     int         i;
    2144             : 
    2145     1026146 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2146      944256 :         return;
    2147             : 
    2148       81890 :     trigger = trigdesc->triggers;
    2149      259758 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2150             :     {
    2151      177868 :         pfree(trigger->tgname);
    2152      177868 :         if (trigger->tgnattr > 0)
    2153         934 :             pfree(trigger->tgattr);
    2154      177868 :         if (trigger->tgnargs > 0)
    2155             :         {
    2156       13522 :             while (--(trigger->tgnargs) >= 0)
    2157        7444 :                 pfree(trigger->tgargs[trigger->tgnargs]);
    2158        6078 :             pfree(trigger->tgargs);
    2159             :         }
    2160      177868 :         if (trigger->tgqual)
    2161        1384 :             pfree(trigger->tgqual);
    2162      177868 :         if (trigger->tgoldtable)
    2163        1388 :             pfree(trigger->tgoldtable);
    2164      177868 :         if (trigger->tgnewtable)
    2165        1976 :             pfree(trigger->tgnewtable);
    2166      177868 :         trigger++;
    2167             :     }
    2168       81890 :     pfree(trigdesc->triggers);
    2169       81890 :     pfree(trigdesc);
    2170             : }
    2171             : 
    2172             : /*
    2173             :  * Compare two TriggerDesc structures for logical equality.
    2174             :  */
    2175             : #ifdef NOT_USED
    2176             : bool
    2177             : equalTriggerDescs(TriggerDesc *trigdesc1, TriggerDesc *trigdesc2)
    2178             : {
    2179             :     int         i,
    2180             :                 j;
    2181             : 
    2182             :     /*
    2183             :      * We need not examine the hint flags, just the trigger array itself; if
    2184             :      * we have the same triggers with the same types, the flags should match.
    2185             :      *
    2186             :      * As of 7.3 we assume trigger set ordering is significant in the
    2187             :      * comparison; so we just compare corresponding slots of the two sets.
    2188             :      *
    2189             :      * Note: comparing the stringToNode forms of the WHEN clauses means that
    2190             :      * parse column locations will affect the result.  This is okay as long as
    2191             :      * this function is only used for detecting exact equality, as for example
    2192             :      * in checking for staleness of a cache entry.
    2193             :      */
    2194             :     if (trigdesc1 != NULL)
    2195             :     {
    2196             :         if (trigdesc2 == NULL)
    2197             :             return false;
    2198             :         if (trigdesc1->numtriggers != trigdesc2->numtriggers)
    2199             :             return false;
    2200             :         for (i = 0; i < trigdesc1->numtriggers; i++)
    2201             :         {
    2202             :             Trigger    *trig1 = trigdesc1->triggers + i;
    2203             :             Trigger    *trig2 = trigdesc2->triggers + i;
    2204             : 
    2205             :             if (trig1->tgoid != trig2->tgoid)
    2206             :                 return false;
    2207             :             if (strcmp(trig1->tgname, trig2->tgname) != 0)
    2208             :                 return false;
    2209             :             if (trig1->tgfoid != trig2->tgfoid)
    2210             :                 return false;
    2211             :             if (trig1->tgtype != trig2->tgtype)
    2212             :                 return false;
    2213             :             if (trig1->tgenabled != trig2->tgenabled)
    2214             :                 return false;
    2215             :             if (trig1->tgisinternal != trig2->tgisinternal)
    2216             :                 return false;
    2217             :             if (trig1->tgisclone != trig2->tgisclone)
    2218             :                 return false;
    2219             :             if (trig1->tgconstrrelid != trig2->tgconstrrelid)
    2220             :                 return false;
    2221             :             if (trig1->tgconstrindid != trig2->tgconstrindid)
    2222             :                 return false;
    2223             :             if (trig1->tgconstraint != trig2->tgconstraint)
    2224             :                 return false;
    2225             :             if (trig1->tgdeferrable != trig2->tgdeferrable)
    2226             :                 return false;
    2227             :             if (trig1->tginitdeferred != trig2->tginitdeferred)
    2228             :                 return false;
    2229             :             if (trig1->tgnargs != trig2->tgnargs)
    2230             :                 return false;
    2231             :             if (trig1->tgnattr != trig2->tgnattr)
    2232             :                 return false;
    2233             :             if (trig1->tgnattr > 0 &&
    2234             :                 memcmp(trig1->tgattr, trig2->tgattr,
    2235             :                        trig1->tgnattr * sizeof(int16)) != 0)
    2236             :                 return false;
    2237             :             for (j = 0; j < trig1->tgnargs; j++)
    2238             :                 if (strcmp(trig1->tgargs[j], trig2->tgargs[j]) != 0)
    2239             :                     return false;
    2240             :             if (trig1->tgqual == NULL && trig2->tgqual == NULL)
    2241             :                  /* ok */ ;
    2242             :             else if (trig1->tgqual == NULL || trig2->tgqual == NULL)
    2243             :                 return false;
    2244             :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgqual, trig2->tgqual) != 0)
    2245             :                 return false;
    2246             :             if (trig1->tgoldtable == NULL && trig2->tgoldtable == NULL)
    2247             :                  /* ok */ ;
    2248             :             else if (trig1->tgoldtable == NULL || trig2->tgoldtable == NULL)
    2249             :                 return false;
    2250             :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgoldtable, trig2->tgoldtable) != 0)
    2251             :                 return false;
    2252             :             if (trig1->tgnewtable == NULL && trig2->tgnewtable == NULL)
    2253             :                  /* ok */ ;
    2254             :             else if (trig1->tgnewtable == NULL || trig2->tgnewtable == NULL)
    2255             :                 return false;
    2256             :             else if (strcmp(trig1->tgnewtable, trig2->tgnewtable) != 0)
    2257             :                 return false;
    2258             :         }
    2259             :     }
    2260             :     else if (trigdesc2 != NULL)
    2261             :         return false;
    2262             :     return true;
    2263             : }
    2264             : #endif                          /* NOT_USED */
    2265             : 
    2266             : /*
    2267             :  * Check if there is a row-level trigger with transition tables that prevents
    2268             :  * a table from becoming an inheritance child or partition.  Return the name
    2269             :  * of the first such incompatible trigger, or NULL if there is none.
    2270             :  */
    2271             : const char *
    2272        2370 : FindTriggerIncompatibleWithInheritance(TriggerDesc *trigdesc)
    2273             : {
    2274        2370 :     if (trigdesc != NULL)
    2275             :     {
    2276             :         int         i;
    2277             : 
    2278         336 :         for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; ++i)
    2279             :         {
    2280         246 :             Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2281             : 
    2282         246 :             if (trigger->tgoldtable != NULL || trigger->tgnewtable != NULL)
    2283          12 :                 return trigger->tgname;
    2284             :         }
    2285             :     }
    2286             : 
    2287        2358 :     return NULL;
    2288             : }
    2289             : 
    2290             : /*
    2291             :  * Call a trigger function.
    2292             :  *
    2293             :  *      trigdata: trigger descriptor.
    2294             :  *      tgindx: trigger's index in finfo and instr arrays.
    2295             :  *      finfo: array of cached trigger function call information.
    2296             :  *      instr: optional array of EXPLAIN ANALYZE instrumentation state.
    2297             :  *      per_tuple_context: memory context to execute the function in.
    2298             :  *
    2299             :  * Returns the tuple (or NULL) as returned by the function.
    2300             :  */
    2301             : static HeapTuple
    2302       21844 : ExecCallTriggerFunc(TriggerData *trigdata,
    2303             :                     int tgindx,
    2304             :                     FmgrInfo *finfo,
    2305             :                     Instrumentation *instr,
    2306             :                     MemoryContext per_tuple_context)
    2307             : {
    2308       21844 :     LOCAL_FCINFO(fcinfo, 0);
    2309             :     PgStat_FunctionCallUsage fcusage;
    2310             :     Datum       result;
    2311             :     MemoryContext oldContext;
    2312             : 
    2313             :     /*
    2314             :      * Protect against code paths that may fail to initialize transition table
    2315             :      * info.
    2316             :      */
    2317             :     Assert(((TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_INSERT(trigdata->tg_event) ||
    2318             :              TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(trigdata->tg_event) ||
    2319             :              TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(trigdata->tg_event)) &&
    2320             :             TRIGGER_FIRED_AFTER(trigdata->tg_event) &&
    2321             :             !(trigdata->tg_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE) &&
    2322             :             !(trigdata->tg_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED)) ||
    2323             :            (trigdata->tg_oldtable == NULL && trigdata->tg_newtable == NULL));
    2324             : 
    2325       21844 :     finfo += tgindx;
    2326             : 
    2327             :     /*
    2328             :      * We cache fmgr lookup info, to avoid making the lookup again on each
    2329             :      * call.
    2330             :      */
    2331       21844 :     if (finfo->fn_oid == InvalidOid)
    2332       18686 :         fmgr_info(trigdata->tg_trigger->tgfoid, finfo);
    2333             : 
    2334             :     Assert(finfo->fn_oid == trigdata->tg_trigger->tgfoid);
    2335             : 
    2336             :     /*
    2337             :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, start charging time to this trigger.
    2338             :      */
    2339       21844 :     if (instr)
    2340           0 :         InstrStartNode(instr + tgindx);
    2341             : 
    2342             :     /*
    2343             :      * Do the function evaluation in the per-tuple memory context, so that
    2344             :      * leaked memory will be reclaimed once per tuple. Note in particular that
    2345             :      * any new tuple created by the trigger function will live till the end of
    2346             :      * the tuple cycle.
    2347             :      */
    2348       21844 :     oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(per_tuple_context);
    2349             : 
    2350             :     /*
    2351             :      * Call the function, passing no arguments but setting a context.
    2352             :      */
    2353       21844 :     InitFunctionCallInfoData(*fcinfo, finfo, 0,
    2354             :                              InvalidOid, (Node *) trigdata, NULL);
    2355             : 
    2356       21844 :     pgstat_init_function_usage(fcinfo, &fcusage);
    2357             : 
    2358       21844 :     MyTriggerDepth++;
    2359       21844 :     PG_TRY();
    2360             :     {
    2361       21844 :         result = FunctionCallInvoke(fcinfo);
    2362             :     }
    2363        1366 :     PG_FINALLY();
    2364             :     {
    2365       21844 :         MyTriggerDepth--;
    2366             :     }
    2367       21844 :     PG_END_TRY();
    2368             : 
    2369       20478 :     pgstat_end_function_usage(&fcusage, true);
    2370             : 
    2371       20478 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    2372             : 
    2373             :     /*
    2374             :      * Trigger protocol allows function to return a null pointer, but NOT to
    2375             :      * set the isnull result flag.
    2376             :      */
    2377       20478 :     if (fcinfo->isnull)
    2378           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    2379             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2380             :                  errmsg("trigger function %u returned null value",
    2381             :                         fcinfo->flinfo->fn_oid)));
    2382             : 
    2383             :     /*
    2384             :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, stop charging time to this trigger, and count
    2385             :      * one "tuple returned" (really the number of firings).
    2386             :      */
    2387       20478 :     if (instr)
    2388           0 :         InstrStopNode(instr + tgindx, 1);
    2389             : 
    2390       20478 :     return (HeapTuple) DatumGetPointer(result);
    2391             : }
    2392             : 
    2393             : void
    2394       93022 : ExecBSInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2395             : {
    2396             :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2397             :     int         i;
    2398       93022 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2399             : 
    2400       93022 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2401             : 
    2402       93022 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2403       92810 :         return;
    2404        7240 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_insert_before_statement)
    2405        7028 :         return;
    2406             : 
    2407             :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2408         212 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2409             :                                    CMD_INSERT))
    2410           0 :         return;
    2411             : 
    2412         212 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2413         212 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2414             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2415         212 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2416        1832 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2417             :     {
    2418        1632 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2419             :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2420             : 
    2421        1632 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2422             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2423             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2424             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2425        1408 :             continue;
    2426         224 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2427             :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    2428          30 :             continue;
    2429             : 
    2430         194 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2431         194 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2432             :                                        i,
    2433             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2434             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2435         194 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2436             : 
    2437         182 :         if (newtuple)
    2438           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2439             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2440             :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2441             :     }
    2442             : }
    2443             : 
    2444             : void
    2445       90612 : ExecASInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2446             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2447             : {
    2448       90612 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2449             : 
    2450       90612 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_insert_after_statement)
    2451         448 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2452             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT,
    2453             :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, transition_capture,
    2454             :                               false);
    2455       90612 : }
    2456             : 
    2457             : bool
    2458        2400 : ExecBRInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2459             :                      TupleTableSlot *slot)
    2460             : {
    2461        2400 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2462        2400 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2463             :     bool        should_free;
    2464        2400 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2465             :     int         i;
    2466             : 
    2467        2400 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2468        2400 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2469             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2470             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2471        2400 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2472       11006 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2473             :     {
    2474        8940 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2475             :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    2476             : 
    2477        8940 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2478             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2479             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2480             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2481        4244 :             continue;
    2482        4696 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2483             :                             NULL, NULL, slot))
    2484          50 :             continue;
    2485             : 
    2486        4646 :         if (!newtuple)
    2487        2366 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2488             : 
    2489        4646 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2490        4646 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    2491        4646 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2492        4646 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2493             :                                        i,
    2494             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2495             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2496        4646 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2497        4554 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2498             :         {
    2499         218 :             if (should_free)
    2500          20 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2501         218 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    2502             :         }
    2503        4336 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    2504             :         {
    2505         746 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, slot, false);
    2506             : 
    2507             :             /*
    2508             :              * After a tuple in a partition goes through a trigger, the user
    2509             :              * could have changed the partition key enough that the tuple no
    2510             :              * longer fits the partition.  Verify that.
    2511             :              */
    2512         746 :             if (trigger->tgisclone &&
    2513          66 :                 !ExecPartitionCheck(relinfo, slot, estate, false))
    2514          24 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    2515             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    2516             :                          errmsg("moving row to another partition during a BEFORE FOR EACH ROW trigger is not supported"),
    2517             :                          errdetail("Before executing trigger \"%s\", the row was to be in partition \"%s.%s\".",
    2518             :                                    trigger->tgname,
    2519             :                                    get_namespace_name(RelationGetNamespace(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc)),
    2520             :                                    RelationGetRelationName(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc))));
    2521             : 
    2522         722 :             if (should_free)
    2523          40 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2524             : 
    2525             :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    2526         722 :             newtuple = NULL;
    2527             :         }
    2528             :     }
    2529             : 
    2530        2066 :     return true;
    2531             : }
    2532             : 
    2533             : void
    2534    11611156 : ExecARInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2535             :                      TupleTableSlot *slot, List *recheckIndexes,
    2536             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2537             : {
    2538    11611156 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2539             : 
    2540    11611156 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row) ||
    2541       60300 :         (transition_capture && transition_capture->tcs_insert_new_table))
    2542       65540 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2543             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT,
    2544             :                               true, NULL, slot,
    2545             :                               recheckIndexes, NULL,
    2546             :                               transition_capture,
    2547             :                               false);
    2548    11611156 : }
    2549             : 
    2550             : bool
    2551         180 : ExecIRInsertTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2552             :                      TupleTableSlot *slot)
    2553             : {
    2554         180 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2555         180 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2556             :     bool        should_free;
    2557         180 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2558             :     int         i;
    2559             : 
    2560         180 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2561         180 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT |
    2562             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2563             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    2564         180 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2565         546 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2566             :     {
    2567         384 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2568             :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    2569             : 
    2570         384 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2571             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2572             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    2573             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT))
    2574         204 :             continue;
    2575         180 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2576             :                             NULL, NULL, slot))
    2577           0 :             continue;
    2578             : 
    2579         180 :         if (!newtuple)
    2580         180 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2581             : 
    2582         180 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2583         180 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    2584         180 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2585         180 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2586             :                                        i,
    2587             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2588             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2589         180 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2590         180 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2591             :         {
    2592          18 :             if (should_free)
    2593          18 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2594          18 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    2595             :         }
    2596         162 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    2597             :         {
    2598          36 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, slot, false);
    2599             : 
    2600          36 :             if (should_free)
    2601          36 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    2602             : 
    2603             :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    2604          36 :             newtuple = NULL;
    2605             :         }
    2606             :     }
    2607             : 
    2608         162 :     return true;
    2609             : }
    2610             : 
    2611             : void
    2612       12380 : ExecBSDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2613             : {
    2614             :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2615             :     int         i;
    2616       12380 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2617             : 
    2618       12380 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2619             : 
    2620       12380 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2621       12302 :         return;
    2622        1626 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_delete_before_statement)
    2623        1506 :         return;
    2624             : 
    2625             :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2626         120 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2627             :                                    CMD_DELETE))
    2628          42 :         return;
    2629             : 
    2630          78 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2631          78 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2632             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2633          78 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2634         708 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2635             :     {
    2636         630 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2637             :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2638             : 
    2639         630 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2640             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2641             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2642             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2643         552 :             continue;
    2644          78 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2645             :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    2646          12 :             continue;
    2647             : 
    2648          66 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2649          66 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2650             :                                        i,
    2651             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2652             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2653          66 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2654             : 
    2655          66 :         if (newtuple)
    2656           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2657             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2658             :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2659             :     }
    2660             : }
    2661             : 
    2662             : void
    2663       12220 : ExecASDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2664             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2665             : {
    2666       12220 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2667             : 
    2668       12220 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_delete_after_statement)
    2669         230 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2670             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE,
    2671             :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, transition_capture,
    2672             :                               false);
    2673       12220 : }
    2674             : 
    2675             : /*
    2676             :  * Execute BEFORE ROW DELETE triggers.
    2677             :  *
    2678             :  * True indicates caller can proceed with the delete.  False indicates caller
    2679             :  * need to suppress the delete and additionally if requested, we need to pass
    2680             :  * back the concurrently updated tuple if any.
    2681             :  */
    2682             : bool
    2683         388 : ExecBRDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, EPQState *epqstate,
    2684             :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2685             :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2686             :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2687             :                      TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
    2688             :                      TM_Result *tmresult,
    2689             :                      TM_FailureData *tmfd)
    2690             : {
    2691         388 :     TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2692         388 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2693         388 :     bool        result = true;
    2694         388 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2695             :     HeapTuple   trigtuple;
    2696         388 :     bool        should_free = false;
    2697             :     int         i;
    2698             : 
    2699             :     Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2700         388 :     if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2701             :     {
    2702         372 :         TupleTableSlot *epqslot_candidate = NULL;
    2703             : 
    2704         372 :         if (!GetTupleForTrigger(estate, epqstate, relinfo, tupleid,
    2705             :                                 LockTupleExclusive, slot, &epqslot_candidate,
    2706             :                                 tmresult, tmfd))
    2707          12 :             return false;
    2708             : 
    2709             :         /*
    2710             :          * If the tuple was concurrently updated and the caller of this
    2711             :          * function requested for the updated tuple, skip the trigger
    2712             :          * execution.
    2713             :          */
    2714         356 :         if (epqslot_candidate != NULL && epqslot != NULL)
    2715             :         {
    2716           2 :             *epqslot = epqslot_candidate;
    2717           2 :             return false;
    2718             :         }
    2719             : 
    2720         354 :         trigtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(slot, true, &should_free);
    2721             :     }
    2722             :     else
    2723             :     {
    2724          16 :         trigtuple = fdw_trigtuple;
    2725          16 :         ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, slot, false);
    2726             :     }
    2727             : 
    2728         370 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2729         370 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2730             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2731             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2732         370 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2733        1300 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2734             :     {
    2735             :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2736        1010 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2737             : 
    2738        1010 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2739             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2740             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2741             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2742         634 :             continue;
    2743         376 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2744             :                             NULL, slot, NULL))
    2745          14 :             continue;
    2746             : 
    2747         362 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2748         362 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    2749         362 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2750         362 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2751             :                                        i,
    2752             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2753             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2754         362 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2755         334 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    2756             :         {
    2757          52 :             result = false;     /* tell caller to suppress delete */
    2758          52 :             break;
    2759             :         }
    2760         282 :         if (newtuple != trigtuple)
    2761          56 :             heap_freetuple(newtuple);
    2762             :     }
    2763         342 :     if (should_free)
    2764           0 :         heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    2765             : 
    2766         342 :     return result;
    2767             : }
    2768             : 
    2769             : /*
    2770             :  * Note: is_crosspart_update must be true if the DELETE is being performed
    2771             :  * as part of a cross-partition update.
    2772             :  */
    2773             : void
    2774     1606516 : ExecARDeleteTriggers(EState *estate,
    2775             :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2776             :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2777             :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2778             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    2779             :                      bool is_crosspart_update)
    2780             : {
    2781     1606516 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2782             : 
    2783     1606516 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row) ||
    2784        4998 :         (transition_capture && transition_capture->tcs_delete_old_table))
    2785             :     {
    2786        6188 :         TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2787             : 
    2788             :         Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2789        6188 :         if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2790        6172 :             GetTupleForTrigger(estate,
    2791             :                                NULL,
    2792             :                                relinfo,
    2793             :                                tupleid,
    2794             :                                LockTupleExclusive,
    2795             :                                slot,
    2796             :                                NULL,
    2797             :                                NULL,
    2798             :                                NULL);
    2799             :         else
    2800          16 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, slot, false);
    2801             : 
    2802        6188 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2803             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE,
    2804             :                               true, slot, NULL, NIL, NULL,
    2805             :                               transition_capture,
    2806             :                               is_crosspart_update);
    2807             :     }
    2808     1606516 : }
    2809             : 
    2810             : bool
    2811          60 : ExecIRDeleteTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2812             :                      HeapTuple trigtuple)
    2813             : {
    2814          60 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2815          60 :     TupleTableSlot *slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2816          60 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2817             :     int         i;
    2818             : 
    2819          60 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2820          60 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE |
    2821             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    2822             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    2823          60 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2824             : 
    2825          60 :     ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, slot, false);
    2826             : 
    2827         354 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2828             :     {
    2829             :         HeapTuple   rettuple;
    2830         300 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2831             : 
    2832         300 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2833             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    2834             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    2835             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE))
    2836         240 :             continue;
    2837          60 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2838             :                             NULL, slot, NULL))
    2839           0 :             continue;
    2840             : 
    2841          60 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = slot;
    2842          60 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    2843          60 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2844          60 :         rettuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2845             :                                        i,
    2846             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2847             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2848          60 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2849          60 :         if (rettuple == NULL)
    2850           6 :             return false;       /* Delete was suppressed */
    2851          54 :         if (rettuple != trigtuple)
    2852           0 :             heap_freetuple(rettuple);
    2853             :     }
    2854          54 :     return true;
    2855             : }
    2856             : 
    2857             : void
    2858       14740 : ExecBSUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    2859             : {
    2860             :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    2861             :     int         i;
    2862       14740 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2863             :     Bitmapset  *updatedCols;
    2864             : 
    2865       14740 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2866             : 
    2867       14740 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    2868       14562 :         return;
    2869        4050 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_update_before_statement)
    2870        3872 :         return;
    2871             : 
    2872             :     /* no-op if we already fired BS triggers in this context */
    2873         178 :     if (before_stmt_triggers_fired(RelationGetRelid(relinfo->ri_RelationDesc),
    2874             :                                    CMD_UPDATE))
    2875           0 :         return;
    2876             : 
    2877             :     /* statement-level triggers operate on the parent table */
    2878             :     Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo == NULL);
    2879             : 
    2880         178 :     updatedCols = ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate);
    2881             : 
    2882         178 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    2883         178 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    2884             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    2885         178 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    2886         178 :     LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = updatedCols;
    2887        1600 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    2888             :     {
    2889        1422 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    2890             :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    2891             : 
    2892        1422 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    2893             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    2894             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    2895             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    2896        1244 :             continue;
    2897         178 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    2898             :                             updatedCols, NULL, NULL))
    2899           6 :             continue;
    2900             : 
    2901         172 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    2902         172 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    2903             :                                        i,
    2904             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    2905             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    2906         172 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    2907             : 
    2908         172 :         if (newtuple)
    2909           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    2910             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    2911             :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    2912             :     }
    2913             : }
    2914             : 
    2915             : void
    2916       13950 : ExecASUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2917             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    2918             : {
    2919       13950 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2920             : 
    2921             :     /* statement-level triggers operate on the parent table */
    2922             :     Assert(relinfo->ri_RootResultRelInfo == NULL);
    2923             : 
    2924       13950 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_update_after_statement)
    2925         396 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo, NULL, NULL,
    2926             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE,
    2927             :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL,
    2928             :                               ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate),
    2929             :                               transition_capture,
    2930             :                               false);
    2931       13950 : }
    2932             : 
    2933             : bool
    2934        2578 : ExecBRUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, EPQState *epqstate,
    2935             :                      ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    2936             :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    2937             :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    2938             :                      TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    2939             :                      TM_Result *tmresult,
    2940             :                      TM_FailureData *tmfd)
    2941             : {
    2942        2578 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    2943        2578 :     TupleTableSlot *oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    2944        2578 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    2945             :     HeapTuple   trigtuple;
    2946        2578 :     bool        should_free_trig = false;
    2947        2578 :     bool        should_free_new = false;
    2948        2578 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    2949             :     int         i;
    2950             :     Bitmapset  *updatedCols;
    2951             :     LockTupleMode lockmode;
    2952             : 
    2953             :     /* Determine lock mode to use */
    2954        2578 :     lockmode = ExecUpdateLockMode(estate, relinfo);
    2955             : 
    2956             :     Assert(HeapTupleIsValid(fdw_trigtuple) ^ ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid));
    2957        2578 :     if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL)
    2958             :     {
    2959        2540 :         TupleTableSlot *epqslot_candidate = NULL;
    2960             : 
    2961             :         /* get a copy of the on-disk tuple we are planning to update */
    2962        2540 :         if (!GetTupleForTrigger(estate, epqstate, relinfo, tupleid,
    2963             :                                 lockmode, oldslot, &epqslot_candidate,
    2964             :                                 tmresult, tmfd))
    2965          22 :             return false;       /* cancel the update action */
    2966             : 
    2967             :         /*
    2968             :          * In READ COMMITTED isolation level it's possible that target tuple
    2969             :          * was changed due to concurrent update.  In that case we have a raw
    2970             :          * subplan output tuple in epqslot_candidate, and need to form a new
    2971             :          * insertable tuple using ExecGetUpdateNewTuple to replace the one we
    2972             :          * received in newslot.  Neither we nor our callers have any further
    2973             :          * interest in the passed-in tuple, so it's okay to overwrite newslot
    2974             :          * with the newer data.
    2975             :          */
    2976        2510 :         if (epqslot_candidate != NULL)
    2977             :         {
    2978             :             TupleTableSlot *epqslot_clean;
    2979             : 
    2980           6 :             epqslot_clean = ExecGetUpdateNewTuple(relinfo, epqslot_candidate,
    2981             :                                                   oldslot);
    2982             : 
    2983             :             /*
    2984             :              * Typically, the caller's newslot was also generated by
    2985             :              * ExecGetUpdateNewTuple, so that epqslot_clean will be the same
    2986             :              * slot and copying is not needed.  But do the right thing if it
    2987             :              * isn't.
    2988             :              */
    2989           6 :             if (unlikely(newslot != epqslot_clean))
    2990           0 :                 ExecCopySlot(newslot, epqslot_clean);
    2991             : 
    2992             :             /*
    2993             :              * At this point newslot contains a virtual tuple that may
    2994             :              * reference some fields of oldslot's tuple in some disk buffer.
    2995             :              * If that tuple is in a different page than the original target
    2996             :              * tuple, then our only pin on that buffer is oldslot's, and we're
    2997             :              * about to release it.  Hence we'd better materialize newslot to
    2998             :              * ensure it doesn't contain references into an unpinned buffer.
    2999             :              * (We'd materialize it below anyway, but too late for safety.)
    3000             :              */
    3001           6 :             ExecMaterializeSlot(newslot);
    3002             :         }
    3003             : 
    3004             :         /*
    3005             :          * Here we convert oldslot to a materialized slot holding trigtuple.
    3006             :          * Neither slot passed to the triggers will hold any buffer pin.
    3007             :          */
    3008        2510 :         trigtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(oldslot, true, &should_free_trig);
    3009             :     }
    3010             :     else
    3011             :     {
    3012             :         /* Put the FDW-supplied tuple into oldslot to unify the cases */
    3013          38 :         ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3014          38 :         trigtuple = fdw_trigtuple;
    3015             :     }
    3016             : 
    3017        2548 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3018        2548 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    3019             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    3020             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    3021        2548 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3022        2548 :     updatedCols = ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate);
    3023        2548 :     LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = updatedCols;
    3024       11410 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3025             :     {
    3026        9028 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3027             :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    3028             : 
    3029        9028 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3030             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    3031             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    3032             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    3033        4396 :             continue;
    3034        4632 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3035             :                             updatedCols, oldslot, newslot))
    3036          86 :             continue;
    3037             : 
    3038        4546 :         if (!newtuple)
    3039        2554 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(newslot, true, &should_free_new);
    3040             : 
    3041        4546 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = oldslot;
    3042        4546 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    3043        4546 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    3044        4546 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = newslot;
    3045        4546 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3046        4546 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3047             :                                        i,
    3048             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3049             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3050        4546 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3051             : 
    3052        4518 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    3053             :         {
    3054         138 :             if (should_free_trig)
    3055           0 :                 heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    3056         138 :             if (should_free_new)
    3057           4 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3058         138 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    3059             :         }
    3060        4380 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    3061             :         {
    3062        1298 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, newslot, false);
    3063             : 
    3064             :             /*
    3065             :              * If the tuple returned by the trigger / being stored, is the old
    3066             :              * row version, and the heap tuple passed to the trigger was
    3067             :              * allocated locally, materialize the slot. Otherwise we might
    3068             :              * free it while still referenced by the slot.
    3069             :              */
    3070        1298 :             if (should_free_trig && newtuple == trigtuple)
    3071           0 :                 ExecMaterializeSlot(newslot);
    3072             : 
    3073        1298 :             if (should_free_new)
    3074           2 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3075             : 
    3076             :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    3077        1298 :             newtuple = NULL;
    3078             :         }
    3079             :     }
    3080        2382 :     if (should_free_trig)
    3081           0 :         heap_freetuple(trigtuple);
    3082             : 
    3083        2382 :     return true;
    3084             : }
    3085             : 
    3086             : /*
    3087             :  * Note: 'src_partinfo' and 'dst_partinfo', when non-NULL, refer to the source
    3088             :  * and destination partitions, respectively, of a cross-partition update of
    3089             :  * the root partitioned table mentioned in the query, given by 'relinfo'.
    3090             :  * 'tupleid' in that case refers to the ctid of the "old" tuple in the source
    3091             :  * partition, and 'newslot' contains the "new" tuple in the destination
    3092             :  * partition.  This interface allows to support the requirements of
    3093             :  * ExecCrossPartitionUpdateForeignKey(); is_crosspart_update must be true in
    3094             :  * that case.
    3095             :  */
    3096             : void
    3097      376864 : ExecARUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3098             :                      ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
    3099             :                      ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
    3100             :                      ItemPointer tupleid,
    3101             :                      HeapTuple fdw_trigtuple,
    3102             :                      TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    3103             :                      List *recheckIndexes,
    3104             :                      TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    3105             :                      bool is_crosspart_update)
    3106             : {
    3107      376864 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3108             : 
    3109      376864 :     if ((trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_update_after_row) ||
    3110         360 :         (transition_capture &&
    3111         360 :          (transition_capture->tcs_update_old_table ||
    3112          12 :           transition_capture->tcs_update_new_table)))
    3113             :     {
    3114             :         /*
    3115             :          * Note: if the UPDATE is converted into a DELETE+INSERT as part of
    3116             :          * update-partition-key operation, then this function is also called
    3117             :          * separately for DELETE and INSERT to capture transition table rows.
    3118             :          * In such case, either old tuple or new tuple can be NULL.
    3119             :          */
    3120             :         TupleTableSlot *oldslot;
    3121             :         ResultRelInfo *tupsrc;
    3122             : 
    3123             :         Assert((src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL) ||
    3124             :                !is_crosspart_update);
    3125             : 
    3126        3586 :         tupsrc = src_partinfo ? src_partinfo : relinfo;
    3127        3586 :         oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, tupsrc);
    3128             : 
    3129        3586 :         if (fdw_trigtuple == NULL && ItemPointerIsValid(tupleid))
    3130        3524 :             GetTupleForTrigger(estate,
    3131             :                                NULL,
    3132             :                                tupsrc,
    3133             :                                tupleid,
    3134             :                                LockTupleExclusive,
    3135             :                                oldslot,
    3136             :                                NULL,
    3137             :                                NULL,
    3138             :                                NULL);
    3139          62 :         else if (fdw_trigtuple != NULL)
    3140          20 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(fdw_trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3141             :         else
    3142          42 :             ExecClearTuple(oldslot);
    3143             : 
    3144        3586 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo,
    3145             :                               src_partinfo, dst_partinfo,
    3146             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE,
    3147             :                               true,
    3148             :                               oldslot, newslot, recheckIndexes,
    3149             :                               ExecGetAllUpdatedCols(relinfo, estate),
    3150             :                               transition_capture,
    3151             :                               is_crosspart_update);
    3152             :     }
    3153      376864 : }
    3154             : 
    3155             : bool
    3156         192 : ExecIRUpdateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3157             :                      HeapTuple trigtuple, TupleTableSlot *newslot)
    3158             : {
    3159         192 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3160         192 :     TupleTableSlot *oldslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    3161         192 :     HeapTuple   newtuple = NULL;
    3162             :     bool        should_free;
    3163         192 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    3164             :     int         i;
    3165             : 
    3166         192 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3167         192 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE |
    3168             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW |
    3169             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_INSTEAD;
    3170         192 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3171             : 
    3172         192 :     ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(trigtuple, oldslot, false);
    3173             : 
    3174         738 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3175             :     {
    3176         570 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3177             :         HeapTuple   oldtuple;
    3178             : 
    3179         570 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3180             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW,
    3181             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_INSTEAD,
    3182             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE))
    3183         378 :             continue;
    3184         192 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3185             :                             NULL, oldslot, newslot))
    3186           0 :             continue;
    3187             : 
    3188         192 :         if (!newtuple)
    3189         192 :             newtuple = ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(newslot, true, &should_free);
    3190             : 
    3191         192 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = oldslot;
    3192         192 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = trigtuple;
    3193         192 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = newslot;
    3194         192 :         LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = oldtuple = newtuple;
    3195             : 
    3196         192 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3197         192 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3198             :                                        i,
    3199             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3200             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3201         192 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3202         186 :         if (newtuple == NULL)
    3203             :         {
    3204          18 :             return false;       /* "do nothing" */
    3205             :         }
    3206         168 :         else if (newtuple != oldtuple)
    3207             :         {
    3208          54 :             ExecForceStoreHeapTuple(newtuple, newslot, false);
    3209             : 
    3210          54 :             if (should_free)
    3211          54 :                 heap_freetuple(oldtuple);
    3212             : 
    3213             :             /* signal tuple should be re-fetched if used */
    3214          54 :             newtuple = NULL;
    3215             :         }
    3216             :     }
    3217             : 
    3218         168 :     return true;
    3219             : }
    3220             : 
    3221             : void
    3222        3410 : ExecBSTruncateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    3223             : {
    3224             :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc;
    3225             :     int         i;
    3226        3410 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    3227             : 
    3228        3410 :     trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3229             : 
    3230        3410 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    3231        3398 :         return;
    3232         758 :     if (!trigdesc->trig_truncate_before_statement)
    3233         746 :         return;
    3234             : 
    3235          12 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    3236          12 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event = TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE |
    3237             :         TRIGGER_EVENT_BEFORE;
    3238          12 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3239             : 
    3240          36 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    3241             :     {
    3242          24 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    3243             :         HeapTuple   newtuple;
    3244             : 
    3245          24 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    3246             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT,
    3247             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_BEFORE,
    3248             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE))
    3249          12 :             continue;
    3250          12 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, LocTriggerData.tg_event,
    3251             :                             NULL, NULL, NULL))
    3252           0 :             continue;
    3253             : 
    3254          12 :         LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = trigger;
    3255          12 :         newtuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    3256             :                                        i,
    3257             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigFunctions,
    3258             :                                        relinfo->ri_TrigInstrument,
    3259          12 :                                        GetPerTupleMemoryContext(estate));
    3260             : 
    3261          12 :         if (newtuple)
    3262           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3263             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_E_R_I_E_TRIGGER_PROTOCOL_VIOLATED),
    3264             :                      errmsg("BEFORE STATEMENT trigger cannot return a value")));
    3265             :     }
    3266             : }
    3267             : 
    3268             : void
    3269        3402 : ExecASTruncateTriggers(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo)
    3270             : {
    3271        3402 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    3272             : 
    3273        3402 :     if (trigdesc && trigdesc->trig_truncate_after_statement)
    3274           8 :         AfterTriggerSaveEvent(estate, relinfo,
    3275             :                               NULL, NULL,
    3276             :                               TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE,
    3277             :                               false, NULL, NULL, NIL, NULL, NULL,
    3278             :                               false);
    3279        3402 : }
    3280             : 
    3281             : 
    3282             : /*
    3283             :  * Fetch tuple into "oldslot", dealing with locking and EPQ if necessary
    3284             :  */
    3285             : static bool
    3286       12608 : GetTupleForTrigger(EState *estate,
    3287             :                    EPQState *epqstate,
    3288             :                    ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3289             :                    ItemPointer tid,
    3290             :                    LockTupleMode lockmode,
    3291             :                    TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    3292             :                    TupleTableSlot **epqslot,
    3293             :                    TM_Result *tmresultp,
    3294             :                    TM_FailureData *tmfdp)
    3295             : {
    3296       12608 :     Relation    relation = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    3297             : 
    3298       12608 :     if (epqslot != NULL)
    3299             :     {
    3300             :         TM_Result   test;
    3301             :         TM_FailureData tmfd;
    3302        2912 :         int         lockflags = 0;
    3303             : 
    3304        2912 :         *epqslot = NULL;
    3305             : 
    3306             :         /* caller must pass an epqstate if EvalPlanQual is possible */
    3307             :         Assert(epqstate != NULL);
    3308             : 
    3309             :         /*
    3310             :          * lock tuple for update
    3311             :          */
    3312        2912 :         if (!IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3313        2048 :             lockflags |= TUPLE_LOCK_FLAG_FIND_LAST_VERSION;
    3314        2912 :         test = table_tuple_lock(relation, tid, estate->es_snapshot, oldslot,
    3315             :                                 estate->es_output_cid,
    3316             :                                 lockmode, LockWaitBlock,
    3317             :                                 lockflags,
    3318             :                                 &tmfd);
    3319             : 
    3320             :         /* Let the caller know about the status of this operation */
    3321        2908 :         if (tmresultp)
    3322         216 :             *tmresultp = test;
    3323        2908 :         if (tmfdp)
    3324        2902 :             *tmfdp = tmfd;
    3325             : 
    3326        2908 :         switch (test)
    3327             :         {
    3328           6 :             case TM_SelfModified:
    3329             : 
    3330             :                 /*
    3331             :                  * The target tuple was already updated or deleted by the
    3332             :                  * current command, or by a later command in the current
    3333             :                  * transaction.  We ignore the tuple in the former case, and
    3334             :                  * throw error in the latter case, for the same reasons
    3335             :                  * enumerated in ExecUpdate and ExecDelete in
    3336             :                  * nodeModifyTable.c.
    3337             :                  */
    3338           6 :                 if (tmfd.cmax != estate->es_output_cid)
    3339           6 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3340             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_TRIGGERED_DATA_CHANGE_VIOLATION),
    3341             :                              errmsg("tuple to be updated was already modified by an operation triggered by the current command"),
    3342             :                              errhint("Consider using an AFTER trigger instead of a BEFORE trigger to propagate changes to other rows.")));
    3343             : 
    3344             :                 /* treat it as deleted; do not process */
    3345          32 :                 return false;
    3346             : 
    3347        2884 :             case TM_Ok:
    3348        2884 :                 if (tmfd.traversed)
    3349             :                 {
    3350             :                     /*
    3351             :                      * Recheck the tuple using EPQ. For MERGE, we leave this
    3352             :                      * to the caller (it must do additional rechecking, and
    3353             :                      * might end up executing a different action entirely).
    3354             :                      */
    3355          26 :                     if (estate->es_plannedstmt->commandType == CMD_MERGE)
    3356             :                     {
    3357          14 :                         if (tmresultp)
    3358          14 :                             *tmresultp = TM_Updated;
    3359          14 :                         return false;
    3360             :                     }
    3361             : 
    3362          12 :                     *epqslot = EvalPlanQual(epqstate,
    3363             :                                             relation,
    3364             :                                             relinfo->ri_RangeTableIndex,
    3365             :                                             oldslot);
    3366             : 
    3367             :                     /*
    3368             :                      * If PlanQual failed for updated tuple - we must not
    3369             :                      * process this tuple!
    3370             :                      */
    3371          12 :                     if (TupIsNull(*epqslot))
    3372             :                     {
    3373           4 :                         *epqslot = NULL;
    3374           4 :                         return false;
    3375             :                     }
    3376             :                 }
    3377        2866 :                 break;
    3378             : 
    3379           2 :             case TM_Updated:
    3380           2 :                 if (IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3381           2 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3382             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_T_R_SERIALIZATION_FAILURE),
    3383             :                              errmsg("could not serialize access due to concurrent update")));
    3384           0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unexpected table_tuple_lock status: %u", test);
    3385             :                 break;
    3386             : 
    3387          16 :             case TM_Deleted:
    3388          16 :                 if (IsolationUsesXactSnapshot())
    3389           2 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3390             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_T_R_SERIALIZATION_FAILURE),
    3391             :                              errmsg("could not serialize access due to concurrent delete")));
    3392             :                 /* tuple was deleted */
    3393          14 :                 return false;
    3394             : 
    3395           0 :             case TM_Invisible:
    3396           0 :                 elog(ERROR, "attempted to lock invisible tuple");
    3397             :                 break;
    3398             : 
    3399           0 :             default:
    3400           0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized table_tuple_lock status: %u", test);
    3401             :                 return false;   /* keep compiler quiet */
    3402             :         }
    3403             :     }
    3404             :     else
    3405             :     {
    3406             :         /*
    3407             :          * We expect the tuple to be present, thus very simple error handling
    3408             :          * suffices.
    3409             :          */
    3410        9696 :         if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(relation, tid, SnapshotAny,
    3411             :                                            oldslot))
    3412           0 :             elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple for trigger");
    3413             :     }
    3414             : 
    3415       12562 :     return true;
    3416             : }
    3417             : 
    3418             : /*
    3419             :  * Is trigger enabled to fire?
    3420             :  */
    3421             : static bool
    3422       24330 : TriggerEnabled(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3423             :                Trigger *trigger, TriggerEvent event,
    3424             :                Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
    3425             :                TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot)
    3426             : {
    3427             :     /* Check replication-role-dependent enable state */
    3428       24330 :     if (SessionReplicationRole == SESSION_REPLICATION_ROLE_REPLICA)
    3429             :     {
    3430         126 :         if (trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_ORIGIN ||
    3431          78 :             trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_DISABLED)
    3432          84 :             return false;
    3433             :     }
    3434             :     else                        /* ORIGIN or LOCAL role */
    3435             :     {
    3436       24204 :         if (trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_FIRES_ON_REPLICA ||
    3437       24202 :             trigger->tgenabled == TRIGGER_DISABLED)
    3438         158 :             return false;
    3439             :     }
    3440             : 
    3441             :     /*
    3442             :      * Check for column-specific trigger (only possible for UPDATE, and in
    3443             :      * fact we *must* ignore tgattr for other event types)
    3444             :      */
    3445       24088 :     if (trigger->tgnattr > 0 && TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event))
    3446             :     {
    3447             :         int         i;
    3448             :         bool        modified;
    3449             : 
    3450         424 :         modified = false;
    3451         556 :         for (i = 0; i < trigger->tgnattr; i++)
    3452             :         {
    3453         472 :             if (bms_is_member(trigger->tgattr[i] - FirstLowInvalidHeapAttributeNumber,
    3454             :                               modifiedCols))
    3455             :             {
    3456         340 :                 modified = true;
    3457         340 :                 break;
    3458             :             }
    3459             :         }
    3460         424 :         if (!modified)
    3461          84 :             return false;
    3462             :     }
    3463             : 
    3464             :     /* Check for WHEN clause */
    3465       24004 :     if (trigger->tgqual)
    3466             :     {
    3467             :         ExprState **predicate;
    3468             :         ExprContext *econtext;
    3469             :         MemoryContext oldContext;
    3470             :         int         i;
    3471             : 
    3472             :         Assert(estate != NULL);
    3473             : 
    3474             :         /*
    3475             :          * trigger is an element of relinfo->ri_TrigDesc->triggers[]; find the
    3476             :          * matching element of relinfo->ri_TrigWhenExprs[]
    3477             :          */
    3478         450 :         i = trigger - relinfo->ri_TrigDesc->triggers;
    3479         450 :         predicate = &relinfo->ri_TrigWhenExprs[i];
    3480             : 
    3481             :         /*
    3482             :          * If first time through for this WHEN expression, build expression
    3483             :          * nodetrees for it.  Keep them in the per-query memory context so
    3484             :          * they'll survive throughout the query.
    3485             :          */
    3486         450 :         if (*predicate == NULL)
    3487             :         {
    3488             :             Node       *tgqual;
    3489             : 
    3490         242 :             oldContext = MemoryContextSwitchTo(estate->es_query_cxt);
    3491         242 :             tgqual = stringToNode(trigger->tgqual);
    3492             :             /* Change references to OLD and NEW to INNER_VAR and OUTER_VAR */
    3493         242 :             ChangeVarNodes(tgqual, PRS2_OLD_VARNO, INNER_VAR, 0);
    3494         242 :             ChangeVarNodes(tgqual, PRS2_NEW_VARNO, OUTER_VAR, 0);
    3495             :             /* ExecPrepareQual wants implicit-AND form */
    3496         242 :             tgqual = (Node *) make_ands_implicit((Expr *) tgqual);
    3497         242 :             *predicate = ExecPrepareQual((List *) tgqual, estate);
    3498         242 :             MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldContext);
    3499             :         }
    3500             : 
    3501             :         /*
    3502             :          * We will use the EState's per-tuple context for evaluating WHEN
    3503             :          * expressions (creating it if it's not already there).
    3504             :          */
    3505         450 :         econtext = GetPerTupleExprContext(estate);
    3506             : 
    3507             :         /*
    3508             :          * Finally evaluate the expression, making the old and/or new tuples
    3509             :          * available as INNER_VAR/OUTER_VAR respectively.
    3510             :          */
    3511         450 :         econtext->ecxt_innertuple = oldslot;
    3512         450 :         econtext->ecxt_outertuple = newslot;
    3513         450 :         if (!ExecQual(*predicate, econtext))
    3514         240 :             return false;
    3515             :     }
    3516             : 
    3517       23764 :     return true;
    3518             : }
    3519             : 
    3520             : 
    3521             : /* ----------
    3522             :  * After-trigger stuff
    3523             :  *
    3524             :  * The AfterTriggersData struct holds data about pending AFTER trigger events
    3525             :  * during the current transaction tree.  (BEFORE triggers are fired
    3526             :  * immediately so we don't need any persistent state about them.)  The struct
    3527             :  * and most of its subsidiary data are kept in TopTransactionContext; however
    3528             :  * some data that can be discarded sooner appears in the CurTransactionContext
    3529             :  * of the relevant subtransaction.  Also, the individual event records are
    3530             :  * kept in a separate sub-context of TopTransactionContext.  This is done
    3531             :  * mainly so that it's easy to tell from a memory context dump how much space
    3532             :  * is being eaten by trigger events.
    3533             :  *
    3534             :  * Because the list of pending events can grow large, we go to some
    3535             :  * considerable effort to minimize per-event memory consumption.  The event
    3536             :  * records are grouped into chunks and common data for similar events in the
    3537             :  * same chunk is only stored once.
    3538             :  *
    3539             :  * XXX We need to be able to save the per-event data in a file if it grows too
    3540             :  * large.
    3541             :  * ----------
    3542             :  */
    3543             : 
    3544             : /* Per-trigger SET CONSTRAINT status */
    3545             : typedef struct SetConstraintTriggerData
    3546             : {
    3547             :     Oid         sct_tgoid;
    3548             :     bool        sct_tgisdeferred;
    3549             : } SetConstraintTriggerData;
    3550             : 
    3551             : typedef struct SetConstraintTriggerData *SetConstraintTrigger;
    3552             : 
    3553             : /*
    3554             :  * SET CONSTRAINT intra-transaction status.
    3555             :  *
    3556             :  * We make this a single palloc'd object so it can be copied and freed easily.
    3557             :  *
    3558             :  * all_isset and all_isdeferred are used to keep track
    3559             :  * of SET CONSTRAINTS ALL {DEFERRED, IMMEDIATE}.
    3560             :  *
    3561             :  * trigstates[] stores per-trigger tgisdeferred settings.
    3562             :  */
    3563             : typedef struct SetConstraintStateData
    3564             : {
    3565             :     bool        all_isset;
    3566             :     bool        all_isdeferred;
    3567             :     int         numstates;      /* number of trigstates[] entries in use */
    3568             :     int         numalloc;       /* allocated size of trigstates[] */
    3569             :     SetConstraintTriggerData trigstates[FLEXIBLE_ARRAY_MEMBER];
    3570             : } SetConstraintStateData;
    3571             : 
    3572             : typedef SetConstraintStateData *SetConstraintState;
    3573             : 
    3574             : 
    3575             : /*
    3576             :  * Per-trigger-event data
    3577             :  *
    3578             :  * The actual per-event data, AfterTriggerEventData, includes DONE/IN_PROGRESS
    3579             :  * status bits, up to two tuple CTIDs, and optionally two OIDs of partitions.
    3580             :  * Each event record also has an associated AfterTriggerSharedData that is
    3581             :  * shared across all instances of similar events within a "chunk".
    3582             :  *
    3583             :  * For row-level triggers, we arrange not to waste storage on unneeded ctid
    3584             :  * fields.  Updates of regular tables use two; inserts and deletes of regular
    3585             :  * tables use one; foreign tables always use zero and save the tuple(s) to a
    3586             :  * tuplestore.  AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH directs AfterTriggerExecute() to
    3587             :  * retrieve a fresh tuple or pair of tuples from that tuplestore, while
    3588             :  * AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE directs it to use the most-recently-retrieved
    3589             :  * tuple(s).  This permits storing tuples once regardless of the number of
    3590             :  * row-level triggers on a foreign table.
    3591             :  *
    3592             :  * When updates on partitioned tables cause rows to move between partitions,
    3593             :  * the OIDs of both partitions are stored too, so that the tuples can be
    3594             :  * fetched; such entries are marked AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE (for "cross-
    3595             :  * partition update").
    3596             :  *
    3597             :  * Note that we need triggers on foreign tables to be fired in exactly the
    3598             :  * order they were queued, so that the tuples come out of the tuplestore in
    3599             :  * the right order.  To ensure that, we forbid deferrable (constraint)
    3600             :  * triggers on foreign tables.  This also ensures that such triggers do not
    3601             :  * get deferred into outer trigger query levels, meaning that it's okay to
    3602             :  * destroy the tuplestore at the end of the query level.
    3603             :  *
    3604             :  * Statement-level triggers always bear AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID, though they
    3605             :  * require no ctid field.  We lack the flag bit space to neatly represent that
    3606             :  * distinct case, and it seems unlikely to be worth much trouble.
    3607             :  *
    3608             :  * Note: ats_firing_id is initially zero and is set to something else when
    3609             :  * AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS is set.  It indicates which trigger firing
    3610             :  * cycle the trigger will be fired in (or was fired in, if DONE is set).
    3611             :  * Although this is mutable state, we can keep it in AfterTriggerSharedData
    3612             :  * because all instances of the same type of event in a given event list will
    3613             :  * be fired at the same time, if they were queued between the same firing
    3614             :  * cycles.  So we need only ensure that ats_firing_id is zero when attaching
    3615             :  * a new event to an existing AfterTriggerSharedData record.
    3616             :  */
    3617             : typedef uint32 TriggerFlags;
    3618             : 
    3619             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET            0x07FFFFFF  /* must be low-order bits */
    3620             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE              0x80000000
    3621             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS       0x40000000
    3622             : /* bits describing the size and tuple sources of this event */
    3623             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE         0x00000000
    3624             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH         0x20000000
    3625             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID             0x10000000
    3626             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID             0x30000000
    3627             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE         0x08000000
    3628             : #define AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS          0x38000000
    3629             : typedef struct AfterTriggerSharedData *AfterTriggerShared;
    3630             : 
    3631             : typedef struct AfterTriggerSharedData
    3632             : {
    3633             :     TriggerEvent ats_event;     /* event type indicator, see trigger.h */
    3634             :     Oid         ats_tgoid;      /* the trigger's ID */
    3635             :     Oid         ats_relid;      /* the relation it's on */
    3636             :     CommandId   ats_firing_id;  /* ID for firing cycle */
    3637             :     struct AfterTriggersTableData *ats_table;   /* transition table access */
    3638             :     Bitmapset  *ats_modifiedcols;   /* modified columns */
    3639             : } AfterTriggerSharedData;
    3640             : 
    3641             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventData *AfterTriggerEvent;
    3642             : 
    3643             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventData
    3644             : {
    3645             :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3646             :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;  /* inserted, deleted, or old updated tuple */
    3647             :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid2;  /* new updated tuple */
    3648             : 
    3649             :     /*
    3650             :      * During a cross-partition update of a partitioned table, we also store
    3651             :      * the OIDs of source and destination partitions that are needed to fetch
    3652             :      * the old (ctid1) and the new tuple (ctid2) from, respectively.
    3653             :      */
    3654             :     Oid         ate_src_part;
    3655             :     Oid         ate_dst_part;
    3656             : } AfterTriggerEventData;
    3657             : 
    3658             : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_src_part, ate_dst_part */
    3659             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids
    3660             : {
    3661             :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;
    3662             :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;
    3663             :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid2;
    3664             : }           AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids;
    3665             : 
    3666             : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_*_part and ate_ctid2 */
    3667             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid
    3668             : {
    3669             :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3670             :     ItemPointerData ate_ctid1;  /* inserted, deleted, or old updated tuple */
    3671             : }           AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid;
    3672             : 
    3673             : /* AfterTriggerEventData, minus ate_*_part, ate_ctid1 and ate_ctid2 */
    3674             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids
    3675             : {
    3676             :     TriggerFlags ate_flags;     /* status bits and offset to shared data */
    3677             : }           AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids;
    3678             : 
    3679             : #define SizeofTriggerEvent(evt) \
    3680             :     (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE ? \
    3681             :      sizeof(AfterTriggerEventData) : \
    3682             :      (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID ? \
    3683             :       sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataNoOids) : \
    3684             :       (((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID ? \
    3685             :        sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataOneCtid) : \
    3686             :        sizeof(AfterTriggerEventDataZeroCtids))))
    3687             : 
    3688             : #define GetTriggerSharedData(evt) \
    3689             :     ((AfterTriggerShared) ((char *) (evt) + ((evt)->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET)))
    3690             : 
    3691             : /*
    3692             :  * To avoid palloc overhead, we keep trigger events in arrays in successively-
    3693             :  * larger chunks (a slightly more sophisticated version of an expansible
    3694             :  * array).  The space between CHUNK_DATA_START and freeptr is occupied by
    3695             :  * AfterTriggerEventData records; the space between endfree and endptr is
    3696             :  * occupied by AfterTriggerSharedData records.
    3697             :  */
    3698             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventChunk
    3699             : {
    3700             :     struct AfterTriggerEventChunk *next;    /* list link */
    3701             :     char       *freeptr;        /* start of free space in chunk */
    3702             :     char       *endfree;        /* end of free space in chunk */
    3703             :     char       *endptr;         /* end of chunk */
    3704             :     /* event data follows here */
    3705             : } AfterTriggerEventChunk;
    3706             : 
    3707             : #define CHUNK_DATA_START(cptr) ((char *) (cptr) + MAXALIGN(sizeof(AfterTriggerEventChunk)))
    3708             : 
    3709             : /* A list of events */
    3710             : typedef struct AfterTriggerEventList
    3711             : {
    3712             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *head;
    3713             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *tail;
    3714             :     char       *tailfree;       /* freeptr of tail chunk */
    3715             : } AfterTriggerEventList;
    3716             : 
    3717             : /* Macros to help in iterating over a list of events */
    3718             : #define for_each_chunk(cptr, evtlist) \
    3719             :     for (cptr = (evtlist).head; cptr != NULL; cptr = cptr->next)
    3720             : #define for_each_event(eptr, cptr) \
    3721             :     for (eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) CHUNK_DATA_START(cptr); \
    3722             :          (char *) eptr < (cptr)->freeptr; \
    3723             :          eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) (((char *) eptr) + SizeofTriggerEvent(eptr)))
    3724             : /* Use this if no special per-chunk processing is needed */
    3725             : #define for_each_event_chunk(eptr, cptr, evtlist) \
    3726             :     for_each_chunk(cptr, evtlist) for_each_event(eptr, cptr)
    3727             : 
    3728             : /* Macros for iterating from a start point that might not be list start */
    3729             : #define for_each_chunk_from(cptr) \
    3730             :     for (; cptr != NULL; cptr = cptr->next)
    3731             : #define for_each_event_from(eptr, cptr) \
    3732             :     for (; \
    3733             :          (char *) eptr < (cptr)->freeptr; \
    3734             :          eptr = (AfterTriggerEvent) (((char *) eptr) + SizeofTriggerEvent(eptr)))
    3735             : 
    3736             : 
    3737             : /*
    3738             :  * All per-transaction data for the AFTER TRIGGERS module.
    3739             :  *
    3740             :  * AfterTriggersData has the following fields:
    3741             :  *
    3742             :  * firing_counter is incremented for each call of afterTriggerInvokeEvents.
    3743             :  * We mark firable events with the current firing cycle's ID so that we can
    3744             :  * tell which ones to work on.  This ensures sane behavior if a trigger
    3745             :  * function chooses to do SET CONSTRAINTS: the inner SET CONSTRAINTS will
    3746             :  * only fire those events that weren't already scheduled for firing.
    3747             :  *
    3748             :  * state keeps track of the transaction-local effects of SET CONSTRAINTS.
    3749             :  * This is saved and restored across failed subtransactions.
    3750             :  *
    3751             :  * events is the current list of deferred events.  This is global across
    3752             :  * all subtransactions of the current transaction.  In a subtransaction
    3753             :  * abort, we know that the events added by the subtransaction are at the
    3754             :  * end of the list, so it is relatively easy to discard them.  The event
    3755             :  * list chunks themselves are stored in event_cxt.
    3756             :  *
    3757             :  * query_depth is the current depth of nested AfterTriggerBeginQuery calls
    3758             :  * (-1 when the stack is empty).
    3759             :  *
    3760             :  * query_stack[query_depth] is the per-query-level data, including these fields:
    3761             :  *
    3762             :  * events is a list of AFTER trigger events queued by the current query.
    3763             :  * None of these are valid until the matching AfterTriggerEndQuery call
    3764             :  * occurs.  At that point we fire immediate-mode triggers, and append any
    3765             :  * deferred events to the main events list.
    3766             :  *
    3767             :  * fdw_tuplestore is a tuplestore containing the foreign-table tuples
    3768             :  * needed by events queued by the current query.  (Note: we use just one
    3769             :  * tuplestore even though more than one foreign table might be involved.
    3770             :  * This is okay because tuplestores don't really care what's in the tuples
    3771             :  * they store; but it's possible that someday it'd break.)
    3772             :  *
    3773             :  * tables is a List of AfterTriggersTableData structs for target tables
    3774             :  * of the current query (see below).
    3775             :  *
    3776             :  * maxquerydepth is just the allocated length of query_stack.
    3777             :  *
    3778             :  * trans_stack holds per-subtransaction data, including these fields:
    3779             :  *
    3780             :  * state is NULL or a pointer to a saved copy of the SET CONSTRAINTS
    3781             :  * state data.  Each subtransaction level that modifies that state first
    3782             :  * saves a copy, which we use to restore the state if we abort.
    3783             :  *
    3784             :  * events is a copy of the events head/tail pointers,
    3785             :  * which we use to restore those values during subtransaction abort.
    3786             :  *
    3787             :  * query_depth is the subtransaction-start-time value of query_depth,
    3788             :  * which we similarly use to clean up at subtransaction abort.
    3789             :  *
    3790             :  * firing_counter is the subtransaction-start-time value of firing_counter.
    3791             :  * We use this to recognize which deferred triggers were fired (or marked
    3792             :  * for firing) within an aborted subtransaction.
    3793             :  *
    3794             :  * We use GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel() to determine the correct array
    3795             :  * index in trans_stack.  maxtransdepth is the number of allocated entries in
    3796             :  * trans_stack.  (By not keeping our own stack pointer, we can avoid trouble
    3797             :  * in cases where errors during subxact abort cause multiple invocations
    3798             :  * of AfterTriggerEndSubXact() at the same nesting depth.)
    3799             :  *
    3800             :  * We create an AfterTriggersTableData struct for each target table of the
    3801             :  * current query, and each operation mode (INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE), that has
    3802             :  * either transition tables or statement-level triggers.  This is used to
    3803             :  * hold the relevant transition tables, as well as info tracking whether
    3804             :  * we already queued the statement triggers.  (We use that info to prevent
    3805             :  * firing the same statement triggers more than once per statement, or really
    3806             :  * once per transition table set.)  These structs, along with the transition
    3807             :  * table tuplestores, live in the (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext.
    3808             :  * That's sufficient lifespan because we don't allow transition tables to be
    3809             :  * used by deferrable triggers, so they only need to survive until
    3810             :  * AfterTriggerEndQuery.
    3811             :  */
    3812             : typedef struct AfterTriggersQueryData AfterTriggersQueryData;
    3813             : typedef struct AfterTriggersTransData AfterTriggersTransData;
    3814             : typedef struct AfterTriggersTableData AfterTriggersTableData;
    3815             : 
    3816             : typedef struct AfterTriggersData
    3817             : {
    3818             :     CommandId   firing_counter; /* next firing ID to assign */
    3819             :     SetConstraintState state;   /* the active S C state */
    3820             :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* deferred-event list */
    3821             :     MemoryContext event_cxt;    /* memory context for events, if any */
    3822             : 
    3823             :     /* per-query-level data: */
    3824             :     AfterTriggersQueryData *query_stack;    /* array of structs shown below */
    3825             :     int         query_depth;    /* current index in above array */
    3826             :     int         maxquerydepth;  /* allocated len of above array */
    3827             : 
    3828             :     /* per-subtransaction-level data: */
    3829             :     AfterTriggersTransData *trans_stack;    /* array of structs shown below */
    3830             :     int         maxtransdepth;  /* allocated len of above array */
    3831             : } AfterTriggersData;
    3832             : 
    3833             : struct AfterTriggersQueryData
    3834             : {
    3835             :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* events pending from this query */
    3836             :     Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore;    /* foreign tuples for said events */
    3837             :     List       *tables;         /* list of AfterTriggersTableData, see below */
    3838             : };
    3839             : 
    3840             : struct AfterTriggersTransData
    3841             : {
    3842             :     /* these fields are just for resetting at subtrans abort: */
    3843             :     SetConstraintState state;   /* saved S C state, or NULL if not yet saved */
    3844             :     AfterTriggerEventList events;   /* saved list pointer */
    3845             :     int         query_depth;    /* saved query_depth */
    3846             :     CommandId   firing_counter; /* saved firing_counter */
    3847             : };
    3848             : 
    3849             : struct AfterTriggersTableData
    3850             : {
    3851             :     /* relid + cmdType form the lookup key for these structs: */
    3852             :     Oid         relid;          /* target table's OID */
    3853             :     CmdType     cmdType;        /* event type, CMD_INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE */
    3854             :     bool        closed;         /* true when no longer OK to add tuples */
    3855             :     bool        before_trig_done;   /* did we already queue BS triggers? */
    3856             :     bool        after_trig_done;    /* did we already queue AS triggers? */
    3857             :     AfterTriggerEventList after_trig_events;    /* if so, saved list pointer */
    3858             : 
    3859             :     /*
    3860             :      * We maintain separate transition tables for UPDATE/INSERT/DELETE since
    3861             :      * MERGE can run all three actions in a single statement. Note that UPDATE
    3862             :      * needs both old and new transition tables whereas INSERT needs only new,
    3863             :      * and DELETE needs only old.
    3864             :      */
    3865             : 
    3866             :     /* "old" transition table for UPDATE, if any */
    3867             :     Tuplestorestate *old_upd_tuplestore;
    3868             :     /* "new" transition table for UPDATE, if any */
    3869             :     Tuplestorestate *new_upd_tuplestore;
    3870             :     /* "old" transition table for DELETE, if any */
    3871             :     Tuplestorestate *old_del_tuplestore;
    3872             :     /* "new" transition table for INSERT, if any */
    3873             :     Tuplestorestate *new_ins_tuplestore;
    3874             : 
    3875             :     TupleTableSlot *storeslot;  /* for converting to tuplestore's format */
    3876             : };
    3877             : 
    3878             : static AfterTriggersData afterTriggers;
    3879             : 
    3880             : static void AfterTriggerExecute(EState *estate,
    3881             :                                 AfterTriggerEvent event,
    3882             :                                 ResultRelInfo *relInfo,
    3883             :                                 ResultRelInfo *src_relInfo,
    3884             :                                 ResultRelInfo *dst_relInfo,
    3885             :                                 TriggerDesc *trigdesc,
    3886             :                                 FmgrInfo *finfo,
    3887             :                                 Instrumentation *instr,
    3888             :                                 MemoryContext per_tuple_context,
    3889             :                                 TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot1,
    3890             :                                 TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot2);
    3891             : static AfterTriggersTableData *GetAfterTriggersTableData(Oid relid,
    3892             :                                                          CmdType cmdType);
    3893             : static TupleTableSlot *GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(AfterTriggersTableData *table,
    3894             :                                                  TupleDesc tupdesc);
    3895             : static Tuplestorestate *GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(int event,
    3896             :                                                         TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    3897             :                                                         TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    3898             :                                                         TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture);
    3899             : static void TransitionTableAddTuple(EState *estate,
    3900             :                                     TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    3901             :                                     ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    3902             :                                     TupleTableSlot *slot,
    3903             :                                     TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple,
    3904             :                                     Tuplestorestate *tuplestore);
    3905             : static void AfterTriggerFreeQuery(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs);
    3906             : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateCreate(int numalloc);
    3907             : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateCopy(SetConstraintState origstate);
    3908             : static SetConstraintState SetConstraintStateAddItem(SetConstraintState state,
    3909             :                                                     Oid tgoid, bool tgisdeferred);
    3910             : static void cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType, int tgevent);
    3911             : 
    3912             : 
    3913             : /*
    3914             :  * Get the FDW tuplestore for the current trigger query level, creating it
    3915             :  * if necessary.
    3916             :  */
    3917             : static Tuplestorestate *
    3918         100 : GetCurrentFDWTuplestore(void)
    3919             : {
    3920             :     Tuplestorestate *ret;
    3921             : 
    3922         100 :     ret = afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].fdw_tuplestore;
    3923         100 :     if (ret == NULL)
    3924             :     {
    3925             :         MemoryContext oldcxt;
    3926             :         ResourceOwner saveResourceOwner;
    3927             : 
    3928             :         /*
    3929             :          * Make the tuplestore valid until end of subtransaction.  We really
    3930             :          * only need it until AfterTriggerEndQuery().
    3931             :          */
    3932          36 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    3933          36 :         saveResourceOwner = CurrentResourceOwner;
    3934          36 :         CurrentResourceOwner = CurTransactionResourceOwner;
    3935             : 
    3936          36 :         ret = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    3937             : 
    3938          36 :         CurrentResourceOwner = saveResourceOwner;
    3939          36 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    3940             : 
    3941          36 :         afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].fdw_tuplestore = ret;
    3942             :     }
    3943             : 
    3944         100 :     return ret;
    3945             : }
    3946             : 
    3947             : /* ----------
    3948             :  * afterTriggerCheckState()
    3949             :  *
    3950             :  *  Returns true if the trigger event is actually in state DEFERRED.
    3951             :  * ----------
    3952             :  */
    3953             : static bool
    3954       11692 : afterTriggerCheckState(AfterTriggerShared evtshared)
    3955             : {
    3956       11692 :     Oid         tgoid = evtshared->ats_tgoid;
    3957       11692 :     SetConstraintState state = afterTriggers.state;
    3958             :     int         i;
    3959             : 
    3960             :     /*
    3961             :      * For not-deferrable triggers (i.e. normal AFTER ROW triggers and
    3962             :      * constraints declared NOT DEFERRABLE), the state is always false.
    3963             :      */
    3964       11692 :     if ((evtshared->ats_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE) == 0)
    3965       10994 :         return false;
    3966             : 
    3967             :     /*
    3968             :      * If constraint state exists, SET CONSTRAINTS might have been executed
    3969             :      * either for this trigger or for all triggers.
    3970             :      */
    3971         698 :     if (state != NULL)
    3972             :     {
    3973             :         /* Check for SET CONSTRAINTS for this specific trigger. */
    3974         312 :         for (i = 0; i < state->numstates; i++)
    3975             :         {
    3976         246 :             if (state->trigstates[i].sct_tgoid == tgoid)
    3977          60 :                 return state->trigstates[i].sct_tgisdeferred;
    3978             :         }
    3979             : 
    3980             :         /* Check for SET CONSTRAINTS ALL. */
    3981          66 :         if (state->all_isset)
    3982          54 :             return state->all_isdeferred;
    3983             :     }
    3984             : 
    3985             :     /*
    3986             :      * Otherwise return the default state for the trigger.
    3987             :      */
    3988         584 :     return ((evtshared->ats_event & AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED) != 0);
    3989             : }
    3990             : 
    3991             : /* ----------
    3992             :  * afterTriggerCopyBitmap()
    3993             :  *
    3994             :  * Copy bitmap into AfterTriggerEvents memory context, which is where the after
    3995             :  * trigger events are kept.
    3996             :  * ----------
    3997             :  */
    3998             : static Bitmapset *
    3999       11742 : afterTriggerCopyBitmap(Bitmapset *src)
    4000             : {
    4001             :     Bitmapset  *dst;
    4002             :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4003             : 
    4004       11742 :     if (src == NULL)
    4005        8120 :         return NULL;
    4006             : 
    4007             :     /* Create event context if we didn't already */
    4008        3622 :     if (afterTriggers.event_cxt == NULL)
    4009        1284 :         afterTriggers.event_cxt =
    4010        1284 :             AllocSetContextCreate(TopTransactionContext,
    4011             :                                   "AfterTriggerEvents",
    4012             :                                   ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4013             : 
    4014        3622 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(afterTriggers.event_cxt);
    4015             : 
    4016        3622 :     dst = bms_copy(src);
    4017             : 
    4018        3622 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4019             : 
    4020        3622 :     return dst;
    4021             : }
    4022             : 
    4023             : /* ----------
    4024             :  * afterTriggerAddEvent()
    4025             :  *
    4026             :  *  Add a new trigger event to the specified queue.
    4027             :  *  The passed-in event data is copied.
    4028             :  * ----------
    4029             :  */
    4030             : static void
    4031       12320 : afterTriggerAddEvent(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4032             :                      AfterTriggerEvent event, AfterTriggerShared evtshared)
    4033             : {
    4034       12320 :     Size        eventsize = SizeofTriggerEvent(event);
    4035       12320 :     Size        needed = eventsize + sizeof(AfterTriggerSharedData);
    4036             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4037             :     AfterTriggerShared newshared;
    4038             :     AfterTriggerEvent newevent;
    4039             : 
    4040             :     /*
    4041             :      * If empty list or not enough room in the tail chunk, make a new chunk.
    4042             :      * We assume here that a new shared record will always be needed.
    4043             :      */
    4044       12320 :     chunk = events->tail;
    4045       12320 :     if (chunk == NULL ||
    4046        4606 :         chunk->endfree - chunk->freeptr < needed)
    4047             :     {
    4048             :         Size        chunksize;
    4049             : 
    4050             :         /* Create event context if we didn't already */
    4051        7714 :         if (afterTriggers.event_cxt == NULL)
    4052        5246 :             afterTriggers.event_cxt =
    4053        5246 :                 AllocSetContextCreate(TopTransactionContext,
    4054             :                                       "AfterTriggerEvents",
    4055             :                                       ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4056             : 
    4057             :         /*
    4058             :          * Chunk size starts at 1KB and is allowed to increase up to 1MB.
    4059             :          * These numbers are fairly arbitrary, though there is a hard limit at
    4060             :          * AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET; else we couldn't link event records to their
    4061             :          * shared records using the available space in ate_flags.  Another
    4062             :          * constraint is that if the chunk size gets too huge, the search loop
    4063             :          * below would get slow given a (not too common) usage pattern with
    4064             :          * many distinct event types in a chunk.  Therefore, we double the
    4065             :          * preceding chunk size only if there weren't too many shared records
    4066             :          * in the preceding chunk; otherwise we halve it.  This gives us some
    4067             :          * ability to adapt to the actual usage pattern of the current query
    4068             :          * while still having large chunk sizes in typical usage.  All chunk
    4069             :          * sizes used should be MAXALIGN multiples, to ensure that the shared
    4070             :          * records will be aligned safely.
    4071             :          */
    4072             : #define MIN_CHUNK_SIZE 1024
    4073             : #define MAX_CHUNK_SIZE (1024*1024)
    4074             : 
    4075             : #if MAX_CHUNK_SIZE > (AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET+1)
    4076             : #error MAX_CHUNK_SIZE must not exceed AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET
    4077             : #endif
    4078             : 
    4079        7714 :         if (chunk == NULL)
    4080        7714 :             chunksize = MIN_CHUNK_SIZE;
    4081             :         else
    4082             :         {
    4083             :             /* preceding chunk size... */
    4084           0 :             chunksize = chunk->endptr - (char *) chunk;
    4085             :             /* check number of shared records in preceding chunk */
    4086           0 :             if ((chunk->endptr - chunk->endfree) <=
    4087             :                 (100 * sizeof(AfterTriggerSharedData)))
    4088           0 :                 chunksize *= 2; /* okay, double it */
    4089             :             else
    4090           0 :                 chunksize /= 2; /* too many shared records */
    4091           0 :             chunksize = Min(chunksize, MAX_CHUNK_SIZE);
    4092             :         }
    4093        7714 :         chunk = MemoryContextAlloc(afterTriggers.event_cxt, chunksize);
    4094        7714 :         chunk->next = NULL;
    4095        7714 :         chunk->freeptr = CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    4096        7714 :         chunk->endptr = chunk->endfree = (char *) chunk + chunksize;
    4097             :         Assert(chunk->endfree - chunk->freeptr >= needed);
    4098             : 
    4099        7714 :         if (events->head == NULL)
    4100        7714 :             events->head = chunk;
    4101             :         else
    4102           0 :             events->tail->next = chunk;
    4103        7714 :         events->tail = chunk;
    4104             :         /* events->tailfree is now out of sync, but we'll fix it below */
    4105             :     }
    4106             : 
    4107             :     /*
    4108             :      * Try to locate a matching shared-data record already in the chunk. If
    4109             :      * none, make a new one.
    4110             :      */
    4111       12320 :     for (newshared = ((AfterTriggerShared) chunk->endptr) - 1;
    4112       17544 :          (char *) newshared >= chunk->endfree;
    4113        5224 :          newshared--)
    4114             :     {
    4115        6700 :         if (newshared->ats_tgoid == evtshared->ats_tgoid &&
    4116        1656 :             newshared->ats_relid == evtshared->ats_relid &&
    4117        1656 :             newshared->ats_event == evtshared->ats_event &&
    4118        1650 :             newshared->ats_table == evtshared->ats_table &&
    4119        1614 :             newshared->ats_firing_id == 0)
    4120        1476 :             break;
    4121             :     }
    4122       12320 :     if ((char *) newshared < chunk->endfree)
    4123             :     {
    4124       10844 :         *newshared = *evtshared;
    4125       10844 :         newshared->ats_firing_id = 0;    /* just to be sure */
    4126       10844 :         chunk->endfree = (char *) newshared;
    4127             :     }
    4128             : 
    4129             :     /* Insert the data */
    4130       12320 :     newevent = (AfterTriggerEvent) chunk->freeptr;
    4131       12320 :     memcpy(newevent, event, eventsize);
    4132             :     /* ... and link the new event to its shared record */
    4133       12320 :     newevent->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_OFFSET;
    4134       12320 :     newevent->ate_flags |= (char *) newshared - (char *) newevent;
    4135             : 
    4136       12320 :     chunk->freeptr += eventsize;
    4137       12320 :     events->tailfree = chunk->freeptr;
    4138       12320 : }
    4139             : 
    4140             : /* ----------
    4141             :  * afterTriggerFreeEventList()
    4142             :  *
    4143             :  *  Free all the event storage in the given list.
    4144             :  * ----------
    4145             :  */
    4146             : static void
    4147       16806 : afterTriggerFreeEventList(AfterTriggerEventList *events)
    4148             : {
    4149             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4150             : 
    4151       23104 :     while ((chunk = events->head) != NULL)
    4152             :     {
    4153        6298 :         events->head = chunk->next;
    4154        6298 :         pfree(chunk);
    4155             :     }
    4156       16806 :     events->tail = NULL;
    4157       16806 :     events->tailfree = NULL;
    4158       16806 : }
    4159             : 
    4160             : /* ----------
    4161             :  * afterTriggerRestoreEventList()
    4162             :  *
    4163             :  *  Restore an event list to its prior length, removing all the events
    4164             :  *  added since it had the value old_events.
    4165             :  * ----------
    4166             :  */
    4167             : static void
    4168        9130 : afterTriggerRestoreEventList(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4169             :                              const AfterTriggerEventList *old_events)
    4170             : {
    4171             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4172             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *next_chunk;
    4173             : 
    4174        9130 :     if (old_events->tail == NULL)
    4175             :     {
    4176             :         /* restoring to a completely empty state, so free everything */
    4177        9108 :         afterTriggerFreeEventList(events);
    4178             :     }
    4179             :     else
    4180             :     {
    4181          22 :         *events = *old_events;
    4182             :         /* free any chunks after the last one we want to keep */
    4183          22 :         for (chunk = events->tail->next; chunk != NULL; chunk = next_chunk)
    4184             :         {
    4185           0 :             next_chunk = chunk->next;
    4186           0 :             pfree(chunk);
    4187             :         }
    4188             :         /* and clean up the tail chunk to be the right length */
    4189          22 :         events->tail->next = NULL;
    4190          22 :         events->tail->freeptr = events->tailfree;
    4191             : 
    4192             :         /*
    4193             :          * We don't make any effort to remove now-unused shared data records.
    4194             :          * They might still be useful, anyway.
    4195             :          */
    4196             :     }
    4197        9130 : }
    4198             : 
    4199             : /* ----------
    4200             :  * afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk()
    4201             :  *
    4202             :  *  Remove the first chunk of events from the query level's event list.
    4203             :  *  Keep any event list pointers elsewhere in the query level's data
    4204             :  *  structures in sync.
    4205             :  * ----------
    4206             :  */
    4207             : static void
    4208           0 : afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs)
    4209             : {
    4210           0 :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *target = qs->events.head;
    4211             :     ListCell   *lc;
    4212             : 
    4213             :     Assert(target && target->next);
    4214             : 
    4215             :     /*
    4216             :      * First, update any pointers in the per-table data, so that they won't be
    4217             :      * dangling.  Resetting obsoleted pointers to NULL will make
    4218             :      * cancel_prior_stmt_triggers start from the list head, which is fine.
    4219             :      */
    4220           0 :     foreach(lc, qs->tables)
    4221             :     {
    4222           0 :         AfterTriggersTableData *table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    4223             : 
    4224           0 :         if (table->after_trig_done &&
    4225           0 :             table->after_trig_events.tail == target)
    4226             :         {
    4227           0 :             table->after_trig_events.head = NULL;
    4228           0 :             table->after_trig_events.tail = NULL;
    4229           0 :             table->after_trig_events.tailfree = NULL;
    4230             :         }
    4231             :     }
    4232             : 
    4233             :     /* Now we can flush the head chunk */
    4234           0 :     qs->events.head = target->next;
    4235           0 :     pfree(target);
    4236           0 : }
    4237             : 
    4238             : 
    4239             : /* ----------
    4240             :  * AfterTriggerExecute()
    4241             :  *
    4242             :  *  Fetch the required tuples back from the heap and fire one
    4243             :  *  single trigger function.
    4244             :  *
    4245             :  *  Frequently, this will be fired many times in a row for triggers of
    4246             :  *  a single relation.  Therefore, we cache the open relation and provide
    4247             :  *  fmgr lookup cache space at the caller level.  (For triggers fired at
    4248             :  *  the end of a query, we can even piggyback on the executor's state.)
    4249             :  *
    4250             :  *  When fired for a cross-partition update of a partitioned table, the old
    4251             :  *  tuple is fetched using 'src_relInfo' (the source leaf partition) and
    4252             :  *  the new tuple using 'dst_relInfo' (the destination leaf partition), though
    4253             :  *  both are converted into the root partitioned table's format before passing
    4254             :  *  to the trigger function.
    4255             :  *
    4256             :  *  event: event currently being fired.
    4257             :  *  relInfo: result relation for event.
    4258             :  *  src_relInfo: source partition of a cross-partition update
    4259             :  *  dst_relInfo: its destination partition
    4260             :  *  trigdesc: working copy of rel's trigger info.
    4261             :  *  finfo: array of fmgr lookup cache entries (one per trigger in trigdesc).
    4262             :  *  instr: array of EXPLAIN ANALYZE instrumentation nodes (one per trigger),
    4263             :  *      or NULL if no instrumentation is wanted.
    4264             :  *  per_tuple_context: memory context to call trigger function in.
    4265             :  *  trig_tuple_slot1: scratch slot for tg_trigtuple (foreign tables only)
    4266             :  *  trig_tuple_slot2: scratch slot for tg_newtuple (foreign tables only)
    4267             :  * ----------
    4268             :  */
    4269             : static void
    4270       11414 : AfterTriggerExecute(EState *estate,
    4271             :                     AfterTriggerEvent event,
    4272             :                     ResultRelInfo *relInfo,
    4273             :                     ResultRelInfo *src_relInfo,
    4274             :                     ResultRelInfo *dst_relInfo,
    4275             :                     TriggerDesc *trigdesc,
    4276             :                     FmgrInfo *finfo, Instrumentation *instr,
    4277             :                     MemoryContext per_tuple_context,
    4278             :                     TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot1,
    4279             :                     TupleTableSlot *trig_tuple_slot2)
    4280             : {
    4281       11414 :     Relation    rel = relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4282       11414 :     Relation    src_rel = src_relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4283       11414 :     Relation    dst_rel = dst_relInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4284       11414 :     AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4285       11414 :     Oid         tgoid = evtshared->ats_tgoid;
    4286       11414 :     TriggerData LocTriggerData = {0};
    4287             :     HeapTuple   rettuple;
    4288             :     int         tgindx;
    4289       11414 :     bool        should_free_trig = false;
    4290       11414 :     bool        should_free_new = false;
    4291             : 
    4292             :     /*
    4293             :      * Locate trigger in trigdesc.
    4294             :      */
    4295       25502 :     for (tgindx = 0; tgindx < trigdesc->numtriggers; tgindx++)
    4296             :     {
    4297       25502 :         if (trigdesc->triggers[tgindx].tgoid == tgoid)
    4298             :         {
    4299       11414 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigger = &(trigdesc->triggers[tgindx]);
    4300       11414 :             break;
    4301             :         }
    4302             :     }
    4303       11414 :     if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger == NULL)
    4304           0 :         elog(ERROR, "could not find trigger %u", tgoid);
    4305             : 
    4306             :     /*
    4307             :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, start charging time to this trigger. We want
    4308             :      * to include time spent re-fetching tuples in the trigger cost.
    4309             :      */
    4310       11414 :     if (instr)
    4311           0 :         InstrStartNode(instr + tgindx);
    4312             : 
    4313             :     /*
    4314             :      * Fetch the required tuple(s).
    4315             :      */
    4316       11414 :     switch (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS)
    4317             :     {
    4318          50 :         case AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH:
    4319             :             {
    4320          50 :                 Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore = GetCurrentFDWTuplestore();
    4321             : 
    4322          50 :                 if (!tuplestore_gettupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, true, false,
    4323             :                                              trig_tuple_slot1))
    4324           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple1 for AFTER trigger");
    4325             : 
    4326          50 :                 if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) ==
    4327          18 :                     TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE &&
    4328          18 :                     !tuplestore_gettupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, true, false,
    4329             :                                              trig_tuple_slot2))
    4330           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple2 for AFTER trigger");
    4331             :             }
    4332             :             /* fall through */
    4333             :         case AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE:
    4334             : 
    4335             :             /*
    4336             :              * Store tuple in the slot so that tg_trigtuple does not reference
    4337             :              * tuplestore memory.  (It is formally possible for the trigger
    4338             :              * function to queue trigger events that add to the same
    4339             :              * tuplestore, which can push other tuples out of memory.)  The
    4340             :              * distinction is academic, because we start with a minimal tuple
    4341             :              * that is stored as a heap tuple, constructed in different memory
    4342             :              * context, in the slot anyway.
    4343             :              */
    4344          58 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = trig_tuple_slot1;
    4345          58 :             LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple =
    4346          58 :                 ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(trig_tuple_slot1, true, &should_free_trig);
    4347             : 
    4348          58 :             if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) ==
    4349             :                 TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE)
    4350             :             {
    4351          22 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = trig_tuple_slot2;
    4352          22 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple =
    4353          22 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(trig_tuple_slot2, true, &should_free_new);
    4354             :             }
    4355             :             else
    4356             :             {
    4357          36 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = NULL;
    4358             :             }
    4359          58 :             break;
    4360             : 
    4361       11356 :         default:
    4362       11356 :             if (ItemPointerIsValid(&(event->ate_ctid1)))
    4363             :             {
    4364       10328 :                 TupleTableSlot *src_slot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate,
    4365             :                                                                  src_relInfo);
    4366             : 
    4367       10328 :                 if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(src_rel,
    4368             :                                                    &(event->ate_ctid1),
    4369             :                                                    SnapshotAny,
    4370             :                                                    src_slot))
    4371           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple1 for AFTER trigger");
    4372             : 
    4373             :                 /*
    4374             :                  * Store the tuple fetched from the source partition into the
    4375             :                  * target (root partitioned) table slot, converting if needed.
    4376             :                  */
    4377       10328 :                 if (src_relInfo != relInfo)
    4378             :                 {
    4379         144 :                     TupleConversionMap *map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(src_relInfo);
    4380             : 
    4381         144 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relInfo);
    4382         144 :                     if (map)
    4383             :                     {
    4384          36 :                         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    4385             :                                               src_slot,
    4386             :                                               LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot);
    4387             :                     }
    4388             :                     else
    4389         108 :                         ExecCopySlot(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot, src_slot);
    4390             :                 }
    4391             :                 else
    4392       10184 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot = src_slot;
    4393       10328 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple =
    4394       10328 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot, false, &should_free_trig);
    4395             :             }
    4396             :             else
    4397             :             {
    4398        1028 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple = NULL;
    4399             :             }
    4400             : 
    4401             :             /* don't touch ctid2 if not there */
    4402       11356 :             if (((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) == AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID ||
    4403       11500 :                  (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE)) &&
    4404        3024 :                 ItemPointerIsValid(&(event->ate_ctid2)))
    4405        3024 :             {
    4406        3024 :                 TupleTableSlot *dst_slot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate,
    4407             :                                                                  dst_relInfo);
    4408             : 
    4409        3024 :                 if (!table_tuple_fetch_row_version(dst_rel,
    4410             :                                                    &(event->ate_ctid2),
    4411             :                                                    SnapshotAny,
    4412             :                                                    dst_slot))
    4413           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "failed to fetch tuple2 for AFTER trigger");
    4414             : 
    4415             :                 /*
    4416             :                  * Store the tuple fetched from the destination partition into
    4417             :                  * the target (root partitioned) table slot, converting if
    4418             :                  * needed.
    4419             :                  */
    4420        3024 :                 if (dst_relInfo != relInfo)
    4421             :                 {
    4422         144 :                     TupleConversionMap *map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(dst_relInfo);
    4423             : 
    4424         144 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate, relInfo);
    4425         144 :                     if (map)
    4426             :                     {
    4427          36 :                         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    4428             :                                               dst_slot,
    4429             :                                               LocTriggerData.tg_newslot);
    4430             :                     }
    4431             :                     else
    4432         108 :                         ExecCopySlot(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot, dst_slot);
    4433             :                 }
    4434             :                 else
    4435        2880 :                     LocTriggerData.tg_newslot = dst_slot;
    4436        3024 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple =
    4437        3024 :                     ExecFetchSlotHeapTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot, false, &should_free_new);
    4438             :             }
    4439             :             else
    4440             :             {
    4441        8332 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple = NULL;
    4442             :             }
    4443             :     }
    4444             : 
    4445             :     /*
    4446             :      * Set up the tuplestore information to let the trigger have access to
    4447             :      * transition tables.  When we first make a transition table available to
    4448             :      * a trigger, mark it "closed" so that it cannot change anymore.  If any
    4449             :      * additional events of the same type get queued in the current trigger
    4450             :      * query level, they'll go into new transition tables.
    4451             :      */
    4452       11414 :     LocTriggerData.tg_oldtable = LocTriggerData.tg_newtable = NULL;
    4453       11414 :     if (evtshared->ats_table)
    4454             :     {
    4455         534 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgoldtable)
    4456             :         {
    4457         300 :             if (TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(evtshared->ats_event))
    4458         156 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_oldtable = evtshared->ats_table->old_upd_tuplestore;
    4459             :             else
    4460         144 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_oldtable = evtshared->ats_table->old_del_tuplestore;
    4461         300 :             evtshared->ats_table->closed = true;
    4462             :         }
    4463             : 
    4464         534 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgnewtable)
    4465             :         {
    4466         384 :             if (TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_INSERT(evtshared->ats_event))
    4467         210 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtable = evtshared->ats_table->new_ins_tuplestore;
    4468             :             else
    4469         174 :                 LocTriggerData.tg_newtable = evtshared->ats_table->new_upd_tuplestore;
    4470         384 :             evtshared->ats_table->closed = true;
    4471             :         }
    4472             :     }
    4473             : 
    4474             :     /*
    4475             :      * Setup the remaining trigger information
    4476             :      */
    4477       11414 :     LocTriggerData.type = T_TriggerData;
    4478       11414 :     LocTriggerData.tg_event =
    4479       11414 :         evtshared->ats_event & (TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK | TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW);
    4480       11414 :     LocTriggerData.tg_relation = rel;
    4481       11414 :     if (TRIGGER_FOR_UPDATE(LocTriggerData.tg_trigger->tgtype))
    4482        5302 :         LocTriggerData.tg_updatedcols = evtshared->ats_modifiedcols;
    4483             : 
    4484       11414 :     MemoryContextReset(per_tuple_context);
    4485             : 
    4486             :     /*
    4487             :      * Call the trigger and throw away any possibly returned updated tuple.
    4488             :      * (Don't let ExecCallTriggerFunc measure EXPLAIN time.)
    4489             :      */
    4490       11414 :     rettuple = ExecCallTriggerFunc(&LocTriggerData,
    4491             :                                    tgindx,
    4492             :                                    finfo,
    4493             :                                    NULL,
    4494             :                                    per_tuple_context);
    4495       10214 :     if (rettuple != NULL &&
    4496        3334 :         rettuple != LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple &&
    4497        1408 :         rettuple != LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple)
    4498           0 :         heap_freetuple(rettuple);
    4499             : 
    4500             :     /*
    4501             :      * Release resources
    4502             :      */
    4503       10214 :     if (should_free_trig)
    4504         172 :         heap_freetuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigtuple);
    4505       10214 :     if (should_free_new)
    4506         136 :         heap_freetuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newtuple);
    4507             : 
    4508             :     /* don't clear slots' contents if foreign table */
    4509       10214 :     if (trig_tuple_slot1 == NULL)
    4510             :     {
    4511       10144 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot)
    4512        9170 :             ExecClearTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_trigslot);
    4513       10144 :         if (LocTriggerData.tg_newslot)
    4514        2702 :             ExecClearTuple(LocTriggerData.tg_newslot);
    4515             :     }
    4516             : 
    4517             :     /*
    4518             :      * If doing EXPLAIN ANALYZE, stop charging time to this trigger, and count
    4519             :      * one "tuple returned" (really the number of firings).
    4520             :      */
    4521       10214 :     if (instr)
    4522           0 :         InstrStopNode(instr + tgindx, 1);
    4523       10214 : }
    4524             : 
    4525             : 
    4526             : /*
    4527             :  * afterTriggerMarkEvents()
    4528             :  *
    4529             :  *  Scan the given event list for not yet invoked events.  Mark the ones
    4530             :  *  that can be invoked now with the current firing ID.
    4531             :  *
    4532             :  *  If move_list isn't NULL, events that are not to be invoked now are
    4533             :  *  transferred to move_list.
    4534             :  *
    4535             :  *  When immediate_only is true, do not invoke currently-deferred triggers.
    4536             :  *  (This will be false only at main transaction exit.)
    4537             :  *
    4538             :  *  Returns true if any invokable events were found.
    4539             :  */
    4540             : static bool
    4541      545140 : afterTriggerMarkEvents(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4542             :                        AfterTriggerEventList *move_list,
    4543             :                        bool immediate_only)
    4544             : {
    4545      545140 :     bool        found = false;
    4546      545140 :     bool        deferred_found = false;
    4547             :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    4548             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4549             : 
    4550      566106 :     for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, *events)
    4551             :     {
    4552       13014 :         AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4553       13014 :         bool        defer_it = false;
    4554             : 
    4555       13014 :         if (!(event->ate_flags &
    4556             :               (AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS)))
    4557             :         {
    4558             :             /*
    4559             :              * This trigger hasn't been called or scheduled yet. Check if we
    4560             :              * should call it now.
    4561             :              */
    4562       12174 :             if (immediate_only && afterTriggerCheckState(evtshared))
    4563             :             {
    4564         578 :                 defer_it = true;
    4565             :             }
    4566             :             else
    4567             :             {
    4568             :                 /*
    4569             :                  * Mark it as to be fired in this firing cycle.
    4570             :                  */
    4571       11596 :                 evtshared->ats_firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter;
    4572       11596 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    4573       11596 :                 found = true;
    4574             :             }
    4575             :         }
    4576             : 
    4577             :         /*
    4578             :          * If it's deferred, move it to move_list, if requested.
    4579             :          */
    4580       13014 :         if (defer_it && move_list != NULL)
    4581             :         {
    4582         578 :             deferred_found = true;
    4583             :             /* add it to move_list */
    4584         578 :             afterTriggerAddEvent(move_list, event, evtshared);
    4585             :             /* mark original copy "done" so we don't do it again */
    4586         578 :             event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    4587             :         }
    4588             :     }
    4589             : 
    4590             :     /*
    4591             :      * We could allow deferred triggers if, before the end of the
    4592             :      * security-restricted operation, we were to verify that a SET CONSTRAINTS
    4593             :      * ... IMMEDIATE has fired all such triggers.  For now, don't bother.
    4594             :      */
    4595      545140 :     if (deferred_found && InSecurityRestrictedOperation())
    4596          12 :         ereport(ERROR,
    4597             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INSUFFICIENT_PRIVILEGE),
    4598             :                  errmsg("cannot fire deferred trigger within security-restricted operation")));
    4599             : 
    4600      545128 :     return found;
    4601             : }
    4602             : 
    4603             : /*
    4604             :  * afterTriggerInvokeEvents()
    4605             :  *
    4606             :  *  Scan the given event list for events that are marked as to be fired
    4607             :  *  in the current firing cycle, and fire them.
    4608             :  *
    4609             :  *  If estate isn't NULL, we use its result relation info to avoid repeated
    4610             :  *  openings and closing of trigger target relations.  If it is NULL, we
    4611             :  *  make one locally to cache the info in case there are multiple trigger
    4612             :  *  events per rel.
    4613             :  *
    4614             :  *  When delete_ok is true, it's safe to delete fully-processed events.
    4615             :  *  (We are not very tense about that: we simply reset a chunk to be empty
    4616             :  *  if all its events got fired.  The objective here is just to avoid useless
    4617             :  *  rescanning of events when a trigger queues new events during transaction
    4618             :  *  end, so it's not necessary to worry much about the case where only
    4619             :  *  some events are fired.)
    4620             :  *
    4621             :  *  Returns true if no unfired events remain in the list (this allows us
    4622             :  *  to avoid repeating afterTriggerMarkEvents).
    4623             :  */
    4624             : static bool
    4625        7524 : afterTriggerInvokeEvents(AfterTriggerEventList *events,
    4626             :                          CommandId firing_id,
    4627             :                          EState *estate,
    4628             :                          bool delete_ok)
    4629             : {
    4630        7524 :     bool        all_fired = true;
    4631             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    4632             :     MemoryContext per_tuple_context;
    4633        7524 :     bool        local_estate = false;
    4634        7524 :     ResultRelInfo *rInfo = NULL;
    4635        7524 :     Relation    rel = NULL;
    4636        7524 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = NULL;
    4637        7524 :     FmgrInfo   *finfo = NULL;
    4638        7524 :     Instrumentation *instr = NULL;
    4639        7524 :     TupleTableSlot *slot1 = NULL,
    4640        7524 :                *slot2 = NULL;
    4641             : 
    4642             :     /* Make a local EState if need be */
    4643        7524 :     if (estate == NULL)
    4644             :     {
    4645         330 :         estate = CreateExecutorState();
    4646         330 :         local_estate = true;
    4647             :     }
    4648             : 
    4649             :     /* Make a per-tuple memory context for trigger function calls */
    4650             :     per_tuple_context =
    4651        7524 :         AllocSetContextCreate(CurrentMemoryContext,
    4652             :                               "AfterTriggerTupleContext",
    4653             :                               ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4654             : 
    4655       13848 :     for_each_chunk(chunk, *events)
    4656             :     {
    4657             :         AfterTriggerEvent event;
    4658        7524 :         bool        all_fired_in_chunk = true;
    4659             : 
    4660       19220 :         for_each_event(event, chunk)
    4661             :         {
    4662       12896 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    4663             : 
    4664             :             /*
    4665             :              * Is it one for me to fire?
    4666             :              */
    4667       12896 :             if ((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS) &&
    4668       11414 :                 evtshared->ats_firing_id == firing_id)
    4669       10214 :             {
    4670             :                 ResultRelInfo *src_rInfo,
    4671             :                            *dst_rInfo;
    4672             : 
    4673             :                 /*
    4674             :                  * So let's fire it... but first, find the correct relation if
    4675             :                  * this is not the same relation as before.
    4676             :                  */
    4677       11414 :                 if (rel == NULL || RelationGetRelid(rel) != evtshared->ats_relid)
    4678             :                 {
    4679        7844 :                     rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate, evtshared->ats_relid,
    4680             :                                                     NULL);
    4681        7844 :                     rel = rInfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    4682             :                     /* Catch calls with insufficient relcache refcounting */
    4683             :                     Assert(!RelationHasReferenceCountZero(rel));
    4684        7844 :                     trigdesc = rInfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    4685        7844 :                     finfo = rInfo->ri_TrigFunctions;
    4686        7844 :                     instr = rInfo->ri_TrigInstrument;
    4687        7844 :                     if (slot1 != NULL)
    4688             :                     {
    4689           0 :                         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot1);
    4690           0 :                         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot2);
    4691           0 :                         slot1 = slot2 = NULL;
    4692             :                     }
    4693        7844 :                     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE)
    4694             :                     {
    4695          38 :                         slot1 = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(rel->rd_att,
    4696             :                                                          &TTSOpsMinimalTuple);
    4697          38 :                         slot2 = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(rel->rd_att,
    4698             :                                                          &TTSOpsMinimalTuple);
    4699             :                     }
    4700        7844 :                     if (trigdesc == NULL)   /* should not happen */
    4701           0 :                         elog(ERROR, "relation %u has no triggers",
    4702             :                              evtshared->ats_relid);
    4703             :                 }
    4704             : 
    4705             :                 /*
    4706             :                  * Look up source and destination partition result rels of a
    4707             :                  * cross-partition update event.
    4708             :                  */
    4709       11414 :                 if ((event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_TUP_BITS) ==
    4710             :                     AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE)
    4711             :                 {
    4712             :                     Assert(OidIsValid(event->ate_src_part) &&
    4713             :                            OidIsValid(event->ate_dst_part));
    4714         144 :                     src_rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate,
    4715             :                                                         event->ate_src_part,
    4716             :                                                         rInfo);
    4717         144 :                     dst_rInfo = ExecGetTriggerResultRel(estate,
    4718             :                                                         event->ate_dst_part,
    4719             :                                                         rInfo);
    4720             :                 }
    4721             :                 else
    4722       11270 :                     src_rInfo = dst_rInfo = rInfo;
    4723             : 
    4724             :                 /*
    4725             :                  * Fire it.  Note that the AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS flag is
    4726             :                  * still set, so recursive examinations of the event list
    4727             :                  * won't try to re-fire it.
    4728             :                  */
    4729       11414 :                 AfterTriggerExecute(estate, event, rInfo,
    4730             :                                     src_rInfo, dst_rInfo,
    4731             :                                     trigdesc, finfo, instr,
    4732             :                                     per_tuple_context, slot1, slot2);
    4733             : 
    4734             :                 /*
    4735             :                  * Mark the event as done.
    4736             :                  */
    4737       10214 :                 event->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    4738       10214 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    4739             :             }
    4740        1482 :             else if (!(event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE))
    4741             :             {
    4742             :                 /* something remains to be done */
    4743         516 :                 all_fired = all_fired_in_chunk = false;
    4744             :             }
    4745             :         }
    4746             : 
    4747             :         /* Clear the chunk if delete_ok and nothing left of interest */
    4748        6324 :         if (delete_ok && all_fired_in_chunk)
    4749             :         {
    4750         166 :             chunk->freeptr = CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    4751         166 :             chunk->endfree = chunk->endptr;
    4752             : 
    4753             :             /*
    4754             :              * If it's last chunk, must sync event list's tailfree too.  Note
    4755             :              * that delete_ok must NOT be passed as true if there could be
    4756             :              * additional AfterTriggerEventList values pointing at this event
    4757             :              * list, since we'd fail to fix their copies of tailfree.
    4758             :              */
    4759         166 :             if (chunk == events->tail)
    4760         166 :                 events->tailfree = chunk->freeptr;
    4761             :         }
    4762             :     }
    4763        6324 :     if (slot1 != NULL)
    4764             :     {
    4765          38 :         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot1);
    4766          38 :         ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot2);
    4767             :     }
    4768             : 
    4769             :     /* Release working resources */
    4770        6324 :     MemoryContextDelete(per_tuple_context);
    4771             : 
    4772        6324 :     if (local_estate)
    4773             :     {
    4774         166 :         ExecCloseResultRelations(estate);
    4775         166 :         ExecResetTupleTable(estate->es_tupleTable, false);
    4776         166 :         FreeExecutorState(estate);
    4777             :     }
    4778             : 
    4779        6324 :     return all_fired;
    4780             : }
    4781             : 
    4782             : 
    4783             : /*
    4784             :  * GetAfterTriggersTableData
    4785             :  *
    4786             :  * Find or create an AfterTriggersTableData struct for the specified
    4787             :  * trigger event (relation + operation type).  Ignore existing structs
    4788             :  * marked "closed"; we don't want to put any additional tuples into them,
    4789             :  * nor change their stmt-triggers-fired state.
    4790             :  *
    4791             :  * Note: the AfterTriggersTableData list is allocated in the current
    4792             :  * (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext.  This is OK because
    4793             :  * we don't need it to live past AfterTriggerEndQuery.
    4794             :  */
    4795             : static AfterTriggersTableData *
    4796        2136 : GetAfterTriggersTableData(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    4797             : {
    4798             :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    4799             :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs;
    4800             :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4801             :     ListCell   *lc;
    4802             : 
    4803             :     /* Caller should have ensured query_depth is OK. */
    4804             :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= 0 &&
    4805             :            afterTriggers.query_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth);
    4806        2136 :     qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    4807             : 
    4808        2484 :     foreach(lc, qs->tables)
    4809             :     {
    4810        1408 :         table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    4811        1408 :         if (table->relid == relid && table->cmdType == cmdType &&
    4812        1096 :             !table->closed)
    4813        1060 :             return table;
    4814             :     }
    4815             : 
    4816        1076 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4817             : 
    4818        1076 :     table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) palloc0(sizeof(AfterTriggersTableData));
    4819        1076 :     table->relid = relid;
    4820        1076 :     table->cmdType = cmdType;
    4821        1076 :     qs->tables = lappend(qs->tables, table);
    4822             : 
    4823        1076 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4824             : 
    4825        1076 :     return table;
    4826             : }
    4827             : 
    4828             : /*
    4829             :  * Returns a TupleTableSlot suitable for holding the tuples to be put
    4830             :  * into AfterTriggersTableData's transition table tuplestores.
    4831             :  */
    4832             : static TupleTableSlot *
    4833         294 : GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(AfterTriggersTableData *table,
    4834             :                           TupleDesc tupdesc)
    4835             : {
    4836             :     /* Create it if not already done. */
    4837         294 :     if (!table->storeslot)
    4838             :     {
    4839             :         MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4840             : 
    4841             :         /*
    4842             :          * We need this slot only until AfterTriggerEndQuery, but making it
    4843             :          * last till end-of-subxact is good enough.  It'll be freed by
    4844             :          * AfterTriggerFreeQuery().  However, the passed-in tupdesc might have
    4845             :          * a different lifespan, so we'd better make a copy of that.
    4846             :          */
    4847          84 :         oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4848          84 :         tupdesc = CreateTupleDescCopy(tupdesc);
    4849          84 :         table->storeslot = MakeSingleTupleTableSlot(tupdesc, &TTSOpsVirtual);
    4850          84 :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4851             :     }
    4852             : 
    4853         294 :     return table->storeslot;
    4854             : }
    4855             : 
    4856             : /*
    4857             :  * MakeTransitionCaptureState
    4858             :  *
    4859             :  * Make a TransitionCaptureState object for the given TriggerDesc, target
    4860             :  * relation, and operation type.  The TCS object holds all the state needed
    4861             :  * to decide whether to capture tuples in transition tables.
    4862             :  *
    4863             :  * If there are no triggers in 'trigdesc' that request relevant transition
    4864             :  * tables, then return NULL.
    4865             :  *
    4866             :  * The resulting object can be passed to the ExecAR* functions.  When
    4867             :  * dealing with child tables, the caller can set tcs_original_insert_tuple
    4868             :  * to avoid having to reconstruct the original tuple in the root table's
    4869             :  * format.
    4870             :  *
    4871             :  * Note that we copy the flags from a parent table into this struct (rather
    4872             :  * than subsequently using the relation's TriggerDesc directly) so that we can
    4873             :  * use it to control collection of transition tuples from child tables.
    4874             :  *
    4875             :  * Per SQL spec, all operations of the same kind (INSERT/UPDATE/DELETE)
    4876             :  * on the same table during one query should share one transition table.
    4877             :  * Therefore, the Tuplestores are owned by an AfterTriggersTableData struct
    4878             :  * looked up using the table OID + CmdType, and are merely referenced by
    4879             :  * the TransitionCaptureState objects we hand out to callers.
    4880             :  */
    4881             : TransitionCaptureState *
    4882      119760 : MakeTransitionCaptureState(TriggerDesc *trigdesc, Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    4883             : {
    4884             :     TransitionCaptureState *state;
    4885             :     bool        need_old_upd,
    4886             :                 need_new_upd,
    4887             :                 need_old_del,
    4888             :                 need_new_ins;
    4889             :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    4890             :     MemoryContext oldcxt;
    4891             :     ResourceOwner saveResourceOwner;
    4892             : 
    4893      119760 :     if (trigdesc == NULL)
    4894      107036 :         return NULL;
    4895             : 
    4896             :     /* Detect which table(s) we need. */
    4897       12724 :     switch (cmdType)
    4898             :     {
    4899        7058 :         case CMD_INSERT:
    4900        7058 :             need_old_upd = need_old_del = need_new_upd = false;
    4901        7058 :             need_new_ins = trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table;
    4902        7058 :             break;
    4903        3816 :         case CMD_UPDATE:
    4904        3816 :             need_old_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_old_table;
    4905        3816 :             need_new_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_new_table;
    4906        3816 :             need_old_del = need_new_ins = false;
    4907        3816 :             break;
    4908        1528 :         case CMD_DELETE:
    4909        1528 :             need_old_del = trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table;
    4910        1528 :             need_old_upd = need_new_upd = need_new_ins = false;
    4911        1528 :             break;
    4912         322 :         case CMD_MERGE:
    4913         322 :             need_old_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_old_table;
    4914         322 :             need_new_upd = trigdesc->trig_update_new_table;
    4915         322 :             need_old_del = trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table;
    4916         322 :             need_new_ins = trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table;
    4917         322 :             break;
    4918           0 :         default:
    4919           0 :             elog(ERROR, "unexpected CmdType: %d", (int) cmdType);
    4920             :             /* keep compiler quiet */
    4921             :             need_old_upd = need_new_upd = need_old_del = need_new_ins = false;
    4922             :             break;
    4923             :     }
    4924       12724 :     if (!need_old_upd && !need_new_upd && !need_new_ins && !need_old_del)
    4925       12172 :         return NULL;
    4926             : 
    4927             :     /* Check state, like AfterTriggerSaveEvent. */
    4928         552 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    4929           0 :         elog(ERROR, "MakeTransitionCaptureState() called outside of query");
    4930             : 
    4931             :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    4932         552 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    4933         408 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    4934             : 
    4935             :     /*
    4936             :      * Find or create an AfterTriggersTableData struct to hold the
    4937             :      * tuplestore(s).  If there's a matching struct but it's marked closed,
    4938             :      * ignore it; we need a newer one.
    4939             :      *
    4940             :      * Note: the AfterTriggersTableData list, as well as the tuplestores, are
    4941             :      * allocated in the current (sub)transaction's CurTransactionContext, and
    4942             :      * the tuplestores are managed by the (sub)transaction's resource owner.
    4943             :      * This is sufficient lifespan because we do not allow triggers using
    4944             :      * transition tables to be deferrable; they will be fired during
    4945             :      * AfterTriggerEndQuery, after which it's okay to delete the data.
    4946             :      */
    4947         552 :     table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, cmdType);
    4948             : 
    4949             :     /* Now create required tuplestore(s), if we don't have them already. */
    4950         552 :     oldcxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(CurTransactionContext);
    4951         552 :     saveResourceOwner = CurrentResourceOwner;
    4952         552 :     CurrentResourceOwner = CurTransactionResourceOwner;
    4953             : 
    4954         552 :     if (need_old_upd && table->old_upd_tuplestore == NULL)
    4955         162 :         table->old_upd_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    4956         552 :     if (need_new_upd && table->new_upd_tuplestore == NULL)
    4957         174 :         table->new_upd_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    4958         552 :     if (need_old_del && table->old_del_tuplestore == NULL)
    4959         132 :         table->old_del_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    4960         552 :     if (need_new_ins && table->new_ins_tuplestore == NULL)
    4961         210 :         table->new_ins_tuplestore = tuplestore_begin_heap(false, false, work_mem);
    4962             : 
    4963         552 :     CurrentResourceOwner = saveResourceOwner;
    4964         552 :     MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldcxt);
    4965             : 
    4966             :     /* Now build the TransitionCaptureState struct, in caller's context */
    4967         552 :     state = (TransitionCaptureState *) palloc0(sizeof(TransitionCaptureState));
    4968         552 :     state->tcs_delete_old_table = trigdesc->trig_delete_old_table;
    4969         552 :     state->tcs_update_old_table = trigdesc->trig_update_old_table;
    4970         552 :     state->tcs_update_new_table = trigdesc->trig_update_new_table;
    4971         552 :     state->tcs_insert_new_table = trigdesc->trig_insert_new_table;
    4972         552 :     state->tcs_private = table;
    4973             : 
    4974         552 :     return state;
    4975             : }
    4976             : 
    4977             : 
    4978             : /* ----------
    4979             :  * AfterTriggerBeginXact()
    4980             :  *
    4981             :  *  Called at transaction start (either BEGIN or implicit for single
    4982             :  *  statement outside of transaction block).
    4983             :  * ----------
    4984             :  */
    4985             : void
    4986      570592 : AfterTriggerBeginXact(void)
    4987             : {
    4988             :     /*
    4989             :      * Initialize after-trigger state structure to empty
    4990             :      */
    4991      570592 :     afterTriggers.firing_counter = (CommandId) 1;   /* mustn't be 0 */
    4992      570592 :     afterTriggers.query_depth = -1;
    4993             : 
    4994             :     /*
    4995             :      * Verify that there is no leftover state remaining.  If these assertions
    4996             :      * trip, it means that AfterTriggerEndXact wasn't called or didn't clean
    4997             :      * up properly.
    4998             :      */
    4999             :     Assert(afterTriggers.state == NULL);
    5000             :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_stack == NULL);
    5001             :     Assert(afterTriggers.maxquerydepth == 0);
    5002             :     Assert(afterTriggers.event_cxt == NULL);
    5003             :     Assert(afterTriggers.events.head == NULL);
    5004             :     Assert(afterTriggers.trans_stack == NULL);
    5005             :     Assert(afterTriggers.maxtransdepth == 0);
    5006      570592 : }
    5007             : 
    5008             : 
    5009             : /* ----------
    5010             :  * AfterTriggerBeginQuery()
    5011             :  *
    5012             :  *  Called just before we start processing a single query within a
    5013             :  *  transaction (or subtransaction).  Most of the real work gets deferred
    5014             :  *  until somebody actually tries to queue a trigger event.
    5015             :  * ----------
    5016             :  */
    5017             : void
    5018      417506 : AfterTriggerBeginQuery(void)
    5019             : {
    5020             :     /* Increase the query stack depth */
    5021      417506 :     afterTriggers.query_depth++;
    5022      417506 : }
    5023             : 
    5024             : 
    5025             : /* ----------
    5026             :  * AfterTriggerEndQuery()
    5027             :  *
    5028             :  *  Called after one query has been completely processed. At this time
    5029             :  *  we invoke all AFTER IMMEDIATE trigger events queued by the query, and
    5030             :  *  transfer deferred trigger events to the global deferred-trigger list.
    5031             :  *
    5032             :  *  Note that this must be called BEFORE closing down the executor
    5033             :  *  with ExecutorEnd, because we make use of the EState's info about
    5034             :  *  target relations.  Normally it is called from ExecutorFinish.
    5035             :  * ----------
    5036             :  */
    5037             : void
    5038      413058 : AfterTriggerEndQuery(EState *estate)
    5039             : {
    5040             :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs;
    5041             : 
    5042             :     /* Must be inside a query, too */
    5043             :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= 0);
    5044             : 
    5045             :     /*
    5046             :      * If we never even got as far as initializing the event stack, there
    5047             :      * certainly won't be any events, so exit quickly.
    5048             :      */
    5049      413058 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5050             :     {
    5051      404342 :         afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5052      404342 :         return;
    5053             :     }
    5054             : 
    5055             :     /*
    5056             :      * Process all immediate-mode triggers queued by the query, and move the
    5057             :      * deferred ones to the main list of deferred events.
    5058             :      *
    5059             :      * Notice that we decide which ones will be fired, and put the deferred
    5060             :      * ones on the main list, before anything is actually fired.  This ensures
    5061             :      * reasonably sane behavior if a trigger function does SET CONSTRAINTS ...
    5062             :      * IMMEDIATE: all events we have decided to defer will be available for it
    5063             :      * to fire.
    5064             :      *
    5065             :      * We loop in case a trigger queues more events at the same query level.
    5066             :      * Ordinary trigger functions, including all PL/pgSQL trigger functions,
    5067             :      * will instead fire any triggers in a dedicated query level.  Foreign key
    5068             :      * enforcement triggers do add to the current query level, thanks to their
    5069             :      * passing fire_triggers = false to SPI_execute_snapshot().  Other
    5070             :      * C-language triggers might do likewise.
    5071             :      *
    5072             :      * If we find no firable events, we don't have to increment
    5073             :      * firing_counter.
    5074             :      */
    5075        8716 :     qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    5076             : 
    5077             :     for (;;)
    5078             :     {
    5079        9022 :         if (afterTriggerMarkEvents(&qs->events, &afterTriggers.events, true))
    5080             :         {
    5081        7194 :             CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    5082        7194 :             AfterTriggerEventChunk *oldtail = qs->events.tail;
    5083             : 
    5084        7194 :             if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(&qs->events, firing_id, estate, false))
    5085        5852 :                 break;          /* all fired */
    5086             : 
    5087             :             /*
    5088             :              * Firing a trigger could result in query_stack being repalloc'd,
    5089             :              * so we must recalculate qs after each afterTriggerInvokeEvents
    5090             :              * call.  Furthermore, it's unsafe to pass delete_ok = true here,
    5091             :              * because that could cause afterTriggerInvokeEvents to try to
    5092             :              * access qs->events after the stack has been repalloc'd.
    5093             :              */
    5094         306 :             qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    5095             : 
    5096             :             /*
    5097             :              * We'll need to scan the events list again.  To reduce the cost
    5098             :              * of doing so, get rid of completely-fired chunks.  We know that
    5099             :              * all events were marked IN_PROGRESS or DONE at the conclusion of
    5100             :              * afterTriggerMarkEvents, so any still-interesting events must
    5101             :              * have been added after that, and so must be in the chunk that
    5102             :              * was then the tail chunk, or in later chunks.  So, zap all
    5103             :              * chunks before oldtail.  This is approximately the same set of
    5104             :              * events we would have gotten rid of by passing delete_ok = true.
    5105             :              */
    5106             :             Assert(oldtail != NULL);
    5107         306 :             while (qs->events.head != oldtail)
    5108           0 :                 afterTriggerDeleteHeadEventChunk(qs);
    5109             :         }
    5110             :         else
    5111        1816 :             break;
    5112             :     }
    5113             : 
    5114             :     /* Release query-level-local storage, including tuplestores if any */
    5115        7668 :     AfterTriggerFreeQuery(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth]);
    5116             : 
    5117        7668 :     afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5118             : }
    5119             : 
    5120             : 
    5121             : /*
    5122             :  * AfterTriggerFreeQuery
    5123             :  *  Release subsidiary storage for a trigger query level.
    5124             :  *  This includes closing down tuplestores.
    5125             :  *  Note: it's important for this to be safe if interrupted by an error
    5126             :  *  and then called again for the same query level.
    5127             :  */
    5128             : static void
    5129        7698 : AfterTriggerFreeQuery(AfterTriggersQueryData *qs)
    5130             : {
    5131             :     Tuplestorestate *ts;
    5132             :     List       *tables;
    5133             :     ListCell   *lc;
    5134             : 
    5135             :     /* Drop the trigger events */
    5136        7698 :     afterTriggerFreeEventList(&qs->events);
    5137             : 
    5138             :     /* Drop FDW tuplestore if any */
    5139        7698 :     ts = qs->fdw_tuplestore;
    5140        7698 :     qs->fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    5141        7698 :     if (ts)
    5142          36 :         tuplestore_end(ts);
    5143             : 
    5144             :     /* Release per-table subsidiary storage */
    5145        7698 :     tables = qs->tables;
    5146        8722 :     foreach(lc, tables)
    5147             :     {
    5148        1024 :         AfterTriggersTableData *table = (AfterTriggersTableData *) lfirst(lc);
    5149             : 
    5150        1024 :         ts = table->old_upd_tuplestore;
    5151        1024 :         table->old_upd_tuplestore = NULL;
    5152        1024 :         if (ts)
    5153         150 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5154        1024 :         ts = table->new_upd_tuplestore;
    5155        1024 :         table->new_upd_tuplestore = NULL;
    5156        1024 :         if (ts)
    5157         156 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5158        1024 :         ts = table->old_del_tuplestore;
    5159        1024 :         table->old_del_tuplestore = NULL;
    5160        1024 :         if (ts)
    5161         120 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5162        1024 :         ts = table->new_ins_tuplestore;
    5163        1024 :         table->new_ins_tuplestore = NULL;
    5164        1024 :         if (ts)
    5165         204 :             tuplestore_end(ts);
    5166        1024 :         if (table->storeslot)
    5167             :         {
    5168          84 :             TupleTableSlot *slot = table->storeslot;
    5169             : 
    5170          84 :             table->storeslot = NULL;
    5171          84 :             ExecDropSingleTupleTableSlot(slot);
    5172             :         }
    5173             :     }
    5174             : 
    5175             :     /*
    5176             :      * Now free the AfterTriggersTableData structs and list cells.  Reset list
    5177             :      * pointer first; if list_free_deep somehow gets an error, better to leak
    5178             :      * that storage than have an infinite loop.
    5179             :      */
    5180        7698 :     qs->tables = NIL;
    5181        7698 :     list_free_deep(tables);
    5182        7698 : }
    5183             : 
    5184             : 
    5185             : /* ----------
    5186             :  * AfterTriggerFireDeferred()
    5187             :  *
    5188             :  *  Called just before the current transaction is committed. At this
    5189             :  *  time we invoke all pending DEFERRED triggers.
    5190             :  *
    5191             :  *  It is possible for other modules to queue additional deferred triggers
    5192             :  *  during pre-commit processing; therefore xact.c may have to call this
    5193             :  *  multiple times.
    5194             :  * ----------
    5195             :  */
    5196             : void
    5197      536084 : AfterTriggerFireDeferred(void)
    5198             : {
    5199             :     AfterTriggerEventList *events;
    5200      536084 :     bool        snap_pushed = false;
    5201             : 
    5202             :     /* Must not be inside a query */
    5203             :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth == -1);
    5204             : 
    5205             :     /*
    5206             :      * If there are any triggers to fire, make sure we have set a snapshot for
    5207             :      * them to use.  (Since PortalRunUtility doesn't set a snap for COMMIT, we
    5208             :      * can't assume ActiveSnapshot is valid on entry.)
    5209             :      */
    5210      536084 :     events = &afterTriggers.events;
    5211      536084 :     if (events->head != NULL)
    5212             :     {
    5213         314 :         PushActiveSnapshot(GetTransactionSnapshot());
    5214         314 :         snap_pushed = true;
    5215             :     }
    5216             : 
    5217             :     /*
    5218             :      * Run all the remaining triggers.  Loop until they are all gone, in case
    5219             :      * some trigger queues more for us to do.
    5220             :      */
    5221      536084 :     while (afterTriggerMarkEvents(events, NULL, false))
    5222             :     {
    5223         314 :         CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    5224             : 
    5225         314 :         if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(events, firing_id, NULL, true))
    5226         166 :             break;              /* all fired */
    5227             :     }
    5228             : 
    5229             :     /*
    5230             :      * We don't bother freeing the event list, since it will go away anyway
    5231             :      * (and more efficiently than via pfree) in AfterTriggerEndXact.
    5232             :      */
    5233             : 
    5234      535936 :     if (snap_pushed)
    5235         166 :         PopActiveSnapshot();
    5236      535936 : }
    5237             : 
    5238             : 
    5239             : /* ----------
    5240             :  * AfterTriggerEndXact()
    5241             :  *
    5242             :  *  The current transaction is finishing.
    5243             :  *
    5244             :  *  Any unfired triggers are canceled so we simply throw
    5245             :  *  away anything we know.
    5246             :  *
    5247             :  *  Note: it is possible for this to be called repeatedly in case of
    5248             :  *  error during transaction abort; therefore, do not complain if
    5249             :  *  already closed down.
    5250             :  * ----------
    5251             :  */
    5252             : void
    5253      571002 : AfterTriggerEndXact(bool isCommit)
    5254             : {
    5255             :     /*
    5256             :      * Forget the pending-events list.
    5257             :      *
    5258             :      * Since all the info is in TopTransactionContext or children thereof, we
    5259             :      * don't really need to do anything to reclaim memory.  However, the
    5260             :      * pending-events list could be large, and so it's useful to discard it as
    5261             :      * soon as possible --- especially if we are aborting because we ran out
    5262             :      * of memory for the list!
    5263             :      */
    5264      571002 :     if (afterTriggers.event_cxt)
    5265             :     {
    5266        6530 :         MemoryContextDelete(afterTriggers.event_cxt);
    5267        6530 :         afterTriggers.event_cxt = NULL;
    5268        6530 :         afterTriggers.events.head = NULL;
    5269        6530 :         afterTriggers.events.tail = NULL;
    5270        6530 :         afterTriggers.events.tailfree = NULL;
    5271             :     }
    5272             : 
    5273             :     /*
    5274             :      * Forget any subtransaction state as well.  Since this can't be very
    5275             :      * large, we let the eventual reset of TopTransactionContext free the
    5276             :      * memory instead of doing it here.
    5277             :      */
    5278      571002 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack = NULL;
    5279      571002 :     afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = 0;
    5280             : 
    5281             : 
    5282             :     /*
    5283             :      * Forget the query stack and constraint-related state information.  As
    5284             :      * with the subtransaction state information, we don't bother freeing the
    5285             :      * memory here.
    5286             :      */
    5287      571002 :     afterTriggers.query_stack = NULL;
    5288      571002 :     afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = 0;
    5289      571002 :     afterTriggers.state = NULL;
    5290             : 
    5291             :     /* No more afterTriggers manipulation until next transaction starts. */
    5292      571002 :     afterTriggers.query_depth = -1;
    5293      571002 : }
    5294             : 
    5295             : /*
    5296             :  * AfterTriggerBeginSubXact()
    5297             :  *
    5298             :  *  Start a subtransaction.
    5299             :  */
    5300             : void
    5301       17976 : AfterTriggerBeginSubXact(void)
    5302             : {
    5303       17976 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5304             : 
    5305             :     /*
    5306             :      * Allocate more space in the trans_stack if needed.  (Note: because the
    5307             :      * minimum nest level of a subtransaction is 2, we waste the first couple
    5308             :      * entries of the array; not worth the notational effort to avoid it.)
    5309             :      */
    5310       20694 :     while (my_level >= afterTriggers.maxtransdepth)
    5311             :     {
    5312        2718 :         if (afterTriggers.maxtransdepth == 0)
    5313             :         {
    5314             :             /* Arbitrarily initialize for max of 8 subtransaction levels */
    5315        2634 :             afterTriggers.trans_stack = (AfterTriggersTransData *)
    5316        2634 :                 MemoryContextAlloc(TopTransactionContext,
    5317             :                                    8 * sizeof(AfterTriggersTransData));
    5318        2634 :             afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = 8;
    5319             :         }
    5320             :         else
    5321             :         {
    5322             :             /* repalloc will keep the stack in the same context */
    5323          84 :             int         new_alloc = afterTriggers.maxtransdepth * 2;
    5324             : 
    5325          84 :             afterTriggers.trans_stack = (AfterTriggersTransData *)
    5326          84 :                 repalloc(afterTriggers.trans_stack,
    5327             :                          new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersTransData));
    5328          84 :             afterTriggers.maxtransdepth = new_alloc;
    5329             :         }
    5330             :     }
    5331             : 
    5332             :     /*
    5333             :      * Push the current information into the stack.  The SET CONSTRAINTS state
    5334             :      * is not saved until/unless changed.  Likewise, we don't make a
    5335             :      * per-subtransaction event context until needed.
    5336             :      */
    5337       17976 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5338       17976 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].events = afterTriggers.events;
    5339       17976 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth = afterTriggers.query_depth;
    5340       17976 :     afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].firing_counter = afterTriggers.firing_counter;
    5341       17976 : }
    5342             : 
    5343             : /*
    5344             :  * AfterTriggerEndSubXact()
    5345             :  *
    5346             :  *  The current subtransaction is ending.
    5347             :  */
    5348             : void
    5349       17976 : AfterTriggerEndSubXact(bool isCommit)
    5350             : {
    5351       17976 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5352             :     SetConstraintState state;
    5353             :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    5354             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    5355             :     CommandId   subxact_firing_id;
    5356             : 
    5357             :     /*
    5358             :      * Pop the prior state if needed.
    5359             :      */
    5360       17976 :     if (isCommit)
    5361             :     {
    5362             :         Assert(my_level < afterTriggers.maxtransdepth);
    5363             :         /* If we saved a prior state, we don't need it anymore */
    5364        8846 :         state = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state;
    5365        8846 :         if (state != NULL)
    5366           6 :             pfree(state);
    5367             :         /* this avoids double pfree if error later: */
    5368        8846 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5369             :         Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth ==
    5370             :                afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth);
    5371             :     }
    5372             :     else
    5373             :     {
    5374             :         /*
    5375             :          * Aborting.  It is possible subxact start failed before calling
    5376             :          * AfterTriggerBeginSubXact, in which case we mustn't risk touching
    5377             :          * trans_stack levels that aren't there.
    5378             :          */
    5379        9130 :         if (my_level >= afterTriggers.maxtransdepth)
    5380           0 :             return;
    5381             : 
    5382             :         /*
    5383             :          * Release query-level storage for queries being aborted, and restore
    5384             :          * query_depth to its pre-subxact value.  This assumes that a
    5385             :          * subtransaction will not add events to query levels started in a
    5386             :          * earlier transaction state.
    5387             :          */
    5388        9220 :         while (afterTriggers.query_depth > afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth)
    5389             :         {
    5390          90 :             if (afterTriggers.query_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5391          30 :                 AfterTriggerFreeQuery(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth]);
    5392          90 :             afterTriggers.query_depth--;
    5393             :         }
    5394             :         Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth ==
    5395             :                afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].query_depth);
    5396             : 
    5397             :         /*
    5398             :          * Restore the global deferred-event list to its former length,
    5399             :          * discarding any events queued by the subxact.
    5400             :          */
    5401        9130 :         afterTriggerRestoreEventList(&afterTriggers.events,
    5402        9130 :                                      &afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].events);
    5403             : 
    5404             :         /*
    5405             :          * Restore the trigger state.  If the saved state is NULL, then this
    5406             :          * subxact didn't save it, so it doesn't need restoring.
    5407             :          */
    5408        9130 :         state = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state;
    5409        9130 :         if (state != NULL)
    5410             :         {
    5411           4 :             pfree(afterTriggers.state);
    5412           4 :             afterTriggers.state = state;
    5413             :         }
    5414             :         /* this avoids double pfree if error later: */
    5415        9130 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state = NULL;
    5416             : 
    5417             :         /*
    5418             :          * Scan for any remaining deferred events that were marked DONE or IN
    5419             :          * PROGRESS by this subxact or a child, and un-mark them. We can
    5420             :          * recognize such events because they have a firing ID greater than or
    5421             :          * equal to the firing_counter value we saved at subtransaction start.
    5422             :          * (This essentially assumes that the current subxact includes all
    5423             :          * subxacts started after it.)
    5424             :          */
    5425        9130 :         subxact_firing_id = afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].firing_counter;
    5426        9174 :         for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.events)
    5427             :         {
    5428          22 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    5429             : 
    5430          22 :             if (event->ate_flags &
    5431             :                 (AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS))
    5432             :             {
    5433           4 :                 if (evtshared->ats_firing_id >= subxact_firing_id)
    5434           4 :                     event->ate_flags &=
    5435             :                         ~(AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE | AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS);
    5436             :             }
    5437             :         }
    5438             :     }
    5439             : }
    5440             : 
    5441             : /*
    5442             :  * Get the transition table for the given event and depending on whether we are
    5443             :  * processing the old or the new tuple.
    5444             :  */
    5445             : static Tuplestorestate *
    5446       66084 : GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(int event,
    5447             :                                 TupleTableSlot *oldslot,
    5448             :                                 TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    5449             :                                 TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture)
    5450             : {
    5451       66084 :     Tuplestorestate *tuplestore = NULL;
    5452       66084 :     bool        delete_old_table = transition_capture->tcs_delete_old_table;
    5453       66084 :     bool        update_old_table = transition_capture->tcs_update_old_table;
    5454       66084 :     bool        update_new_table = transition_capture->tcs_update_new_table;
    5455       66084 :     bool        insert_new_table = transition_capture->tcs_insert_new_table;
    5456             : 
    5457             :     /*
    5458             :      * For INSERT events NEW should be non-NULL, for DELETE events OLD should
    5459             :      * be non-NULL, whereas for UPDATE events normally both OLD and NEW are
    5460             :      * non-NULL.  But for UPDATE events fired for capturing transition tuples
    5461             :      * during UPDATE partition-key row movement, OLD is NULL when the event is
    5462             :      * for a row being inserted, whereas NEW is NULL when the event is for a
    5463             :      * row being deleted.
    5464             :      */
    5465             :     Assert(!(event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && delete_old_table &&
    5466             :              TupIsNull(oldslot)));
    5467             :     Assert(!(event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && insert_new_table &&
    5468             :              TupIsNull(newslot)));
    5469             : 
    5470       66084 :     if (!TupIsNull(oldslot))
    5471             :     {
    5472             :         Assert(TupIsNull(newslot));
    5473        5394 :         if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && delete_old_table)
    5474        5040 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_private->old_del_tuplestore;
    5475         354 :         else if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && update_old_table)
    5476         330 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_private->old_upd_tuplestore;
    5477             :     }
    5478       60690 :     else if (!TupIsNull(newslot))
    5479             :     {
    5480             :         Assert(TupIsNull(oldslot));
    5481       60690 :         if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && insert_new_table)
    5482       60336 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_private->new_ins_tuplestore;
    5483         354 :         else if (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && update_new_table)
    5484         348 :             tuplestore = transition_capture->tcs_private->new_upd_tuplestore;
    5485             :     }
    5486             : 
    5487       66084 :     return tuplestore;
    5488             : }
    5489             : 
    5490             : /*
    5491             :  * Add the given heap tuple to the given tuplestore, applying the conversion
    5492             :  * map if necessary.
    5493             :  *
    5494             :  * If original_insert_tuple is given, we can add that tuple without conversion.
    5495             :  */
    5496             : static void
    5497       66084 : TransitionTableAddTuple(EState *estate,
    5498             :                         TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    5499             :                         ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    5500             :                         TupleTableSlot *slot,
    5501             :                         TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple,
    5502             :                         Tuplestorestate *tuplestore)
    5503             : {
    5504             :     TupleConversionMap *map;
    5505             : 
    5506             :     /*
    5507             :      * Nothing needs to be done if we don't have a tuplestore.
    5508             :      */
    5509       66084 :     if (tuplestore == NULL)
    5510          30 :         return;
    5511             : 
    5512       66054 :     if (original_insert_tuple)
    5513         126 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, original_insert_tuple);
    5514       65928 :     else if ((map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(relinfo)) != NULL)
    5515             :     {
    5516         294 :         AfterTriggersTableData *table = transition_capture->tcs_private;
    5517             :         TupleTableSlot *storeslot;
    5518             : 
    5519         294 :         storeslot = GetAfterTriggersStoreSlot(table, map->outdesc);
    5520         294 :         execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap, slot, storeslot);
    5521         294 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, storeslot);
    5522             :     }
    5523             :     else
    5524       65634 :         tuplestore_puttupleslot(tuplestore, slot);
    5525             : }
    5526             : 
    5527             : /* ----------
    5528             :  * AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState()
    5529             :  *
    5530             :  *  Prepare the necessary state so that we can record AFTER trigger events
    5531             :  *  queued by a query.  It is allowed to have nested queries within a
    5532             :  *  (sub)transaction, so we need to have separate state for each query
    5533             :  *  nesting level.
    5534             :  * ----------
    5535             :  */
    5536             : static void
    5537        6860 : AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState(void)
    5538             : {
    5539        6860 :     int         init_depth = afterTriggers.maxquerydepth;
    5540             : 
    5541             :     Assert(afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth);
    5542             : 
    5543        6860 :     if (afterTriggers.maxquerydepth == 0)
    5544             :     {
    5545        6860 :         int         new_alloc = Max(afterTriggers.query_depth + 1, 8);
    5546             : 
    5547        6860 :         afterTriggers.query_stack = (AfterTriggersQueryData *)
    5548        6860 :             MemoryContextAlloc(TopTransactionContext,
    5549             :                                new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersQueryData));
    5550        6860 :         afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = new_alloc;
    5551             :     }
    5552             :     else
    5553             :     {
    5554             :         /* repalloc will keep the stack in the same context */
    5555           0 :         int         old_alloc = afterTriggers.maxquerydepth;
    5556           0 :         int         new_alloc = Max(afterTriggers.query_depth + 1,
    5557             :                                     old_alloc * 2);
    5558             : 
    5559           0 :         afterTriggers.query_stack = (AfterTriggersQueryData *)
    5560           0 :             repalloc(afterTriggers.query_stack,
    5561             :                      new_alloc * sizeof(AfterTriggersQueryData));
    5562           0 :         afterTriggers.maxquerydepth = new_alloc;
    5563             :     }
    5564             : 
    5565             :     /* Initialize new array entries to empty */
    5566       61740 :     while (init_depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    5567             :     {
    5568       54880 :         AfterTriggersQueryData *qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[init_depth];
    5569             : 
    5570       54880 :         qs->events.head = NULL;
    5571       54880 :         qs->events.tail = NULL;
    5572       54880 :         qs->events.tailfree = NULL;
    5573       54880 :         qs->fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    5574       54880 :         qs->tables = NIL;
    5575             : 
    5576       54880 :         ++init_depth;
    5577             :     }
    5578        6860 : }
    5579             : 
    5580             : /*
    5581             :  * Create an empty SetConstraintState with room for numalloc trigstates
    5582             :  */
    5583             : static SetConstraintState
    5584          96 : SetConstraintStateCreate(int numalloc)
    5585             : {
    5586             :     SetConstraintState state;
    5587             : 
    5588             :     /* Behave sanely with numalloc == 0 */
    5589          96 :     if (numalloc <= 0)
    5590          10 :         numalloc = 1;
    5591             : 
    5592             :     /*
    5593             :      * We assume that zeroing will correctly initialize the state values.
    5594             :      */
    5595             :     state = (SetConstraintState)
    5596          96 :         MemoryContextAllocZero(TopTransactionContext,
    5597             :                                offsetof(SetConstraintStateData, trigstates) +
    5598          96 :                                numalloc * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5599             : 
    5600          96 :     state->numalloc = numalloc;
    5601             : 
    5602          96 :     return state;
    5603             : }
    5604             : 
    5605             : /*
    5606             :  * Copy a SetConstraintState
    5607             :  */
    5608             : static SetConstraintState
    5609          10 : SetConstraintStateCopy(SetConstraintState origstate)
    5610             : {
    5611             :     SetConstraintState state;
    5612             : 
    5613          10 :     state = SetConstraintStateCreate(origstate->numstates);
    5614             : 
    5615          10 :     state->all_isset = origstate->all_isset;
    5616          10 :     state->all_isdeferred = origstate->all_isdeferred;
    5617          10 :     state->numstates = origstate->numstates;
    5618          10 :     memcpy(state->trigstates, origstate->trigstates,
    5619          10 :            origstate->numstates * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5620             : 
    5621          10 :     return state;
    5622             : }
    5623             : 
    5624             : /*
    5625             :  * Add a per-trigger item to a SetConstraintState.  Returns possibly-changed
    5626             :  * pointer to the state object (it will change if we have to repalloc).
    5627             :  */
    5628             : static SetConstraintState
    5629         342 : SetConstraintStateAddItem(SetConstraintState state,
    5630             :                           Oid tgoid, bool tgisdeferred)
    5631             : {
    5632         342 :     if (state->numstates >= state->numalloc)
    5633             :     {
    5634          30 :         int         newalloc = state->numalloc * 2;
    5635             : 
    5636          30 :         newalloc = Max(newalloc, 8);    /* in case original has size 0 */
    5637             :         state = (SetConstraintState)
    5638          30 :             repalloc(state,
    5639             :                      offsetof(SetConstraintStateData, trigstates) +
    5640          30 :                      newalloc * sizeof(SetConstraintTriggerData));
    5641          30 :         state->numalloc = newalloc;
    5642             :         Assert(state->numstates < state->numalloc);
    5643             :     }
    5644             : 
    5645         342 :     state->trigstates[state->numstates].sct_tgoid = tgoid;
    5646         342 :     state->trigstates[state->numstates].sct_tgisdeferred = tgisdeferred;
    5647         342 :     state->numstates++;
    5648             : 
    5649         342 :     return state;
    5650             : }
    5651             : 
    5652             : /* ----------
    5653             :  * AfterTriggerSetState()
    5654             :  *
    5655             :  *  Execute the SET CONSTRAINTS ... utility command.
    5656             :  * ----------
    5657             :  */
    5658             : void
    5659         102 : AfterTriggerSetState(ConstraintsSetStmt *stmt)
    5660             : {
    5661         102 :     int         my_level = GetCurrentTransactionNestLevel();
    5662             : 
    5663             :     /* If we haven't already done so, initialize our state. */
    5664         102 :     if (afterTriggers.state == NULL)
    5665          86 :         afterTriggers.state = SetConstraintStateCreate(8);
    5666             : 
    5667             :     /*
    5668             :      * If in a subtransaction, and we didn't save the current state already,
    5669             :      * save it so it can be restored if the subtransaction aborts.
    5670             :      */
    5671         102 :     if (my_level > 1 &&
    5672          10 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state == NULL)
    5673             :     {
    5674          10 :         afterTriggers.trans_stack[my_level].state =
    5675          10 :             SetConstraintStateCopy(afterTriggers.state);
    5676             :     }
    5677             : 
    5678             :     /*
    5679             :      * Handle SET CONSTRAINTS ALL ...
    5680             :      */
    5681         102 :     if (stmt->constraints == NIL)
    5682             :     {
    5683             :         /*
    5684             :          * Forget any previous SET CONSTRAINTS commands in this transaction.
    5685             :          */
    5686          54 :         afterTriggers.state->numstates = 0;
    5687             : 
    5688             :         /*
    5689             :          * Set the per-transaction ALL state to known.
    5690             :          */
    5691          54 :         afterTriggers.state->all_isset = true;
    5692          54 :         afterTriggers.state->all_isdeferred = stmt->deferred;
    5693             :     }
    5694             :     else
    5695             :     {
    5696             :         Relation    conrel;
    5697             :         Relation    tgrel;
    5698          48 :         List       *conoidlist = NIL;
    5699          48 :         List       *tgoidlist = NIL;
    5700             :         ListCell   *lc;
    5701             : 
    5702             :         /*
    5703             :          * Handle SET CONSTRAINTS constraint-name [, ...]
    5704             :          *
    5705             :          * First, identify all the named constraints and make a list of their
    5706             :          * OIDs.  Since, unlike the SQL spec, we allow multiple constraints of
    5707             :          * the same name within a schema, the specifications are not
    5708             :          * necessarily unique.  Our strategy is to target all matching
    5709             :          * constraints within the first search-path schema that has any
    5710             :          * matches, but disregard matches in schemas beyond the first match.
    5711             :          * (This is a bit odd but it's the historical behavior.)
    5712             :          *
    5713             :          * A constraint in a partitioned table may have corresponding
    5714             :          * constraints in the partitions.  Grab those too.
    5715             :          */
    5716          48 :         conrel = table_open(ConstraintRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    5717             : 
    5718          96 :         foreach(lc, stmt->constraints)
    5719             :         {
    5720          48 :             RangeVar   *constraint = lfirst(lc);
    5721             :             bool        found;
    5722             :             List       *namespacelist;
    5723             :             ListCell   *nslc;
    5724             : 
    5725          48 :             if (constraint->catalogname)
    5726             :             {
    5727           0 :                 if (strcmp(constraint->catalogname, get_database_name(MyDatabaseId)) != 0)
    5728           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    5729             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED),
    5730             :                              errmsg("cross-database references are not implemented: \"%s.%s.%s\"",
    5731             :                                     constraint->catalogname, constraint->schemaname,
    5732             :                                     constraint->relname)));
    5733             :             }
    5734             : 
    5735             :             /*
    5736             :              * If we're given the schema name with the constraint, look only
    5737             :              * in that schema.  If given a bare constraint name, use the
    5738             :              * search path to find the first matching constraint.
    5739             :              */
    5740          48 :             if (constraint->schemaname)
    5741             :             {
    5742          12 :                 Oid         namespaceId = LookupExplicitNamespace(constraint->schemaname,
    5743             :                                                                   false);
    5744             : 
    5745          12 :                 namespacelist = list_make1_oid(namespaceId);
    5746             :             }
    5747             :             else
    5748             :             {
    5749          36 :                 namespacelist = fetch_search_path(true);
    5750             :             }
    5751             : 
    5752          48 :             found = false;
    5753         120 :             foreach(nslc, namespacelist)
    5754             :             {
    5755         120 :                 Oid         namespaceId = lfirst_oid(nslc);
    5756             :                 SysScanDesc conscan;
    5757             :                 ScanKeyData skey[2];
    5758             :                 HeapTuple   tup;
    5759             : 
    5760         120 :                 ScanKeyInit(&skey[0],
    5761             :                             Anum_pg_constraint_conname,
    5762             :                             BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_NAMEEQ,
    5763         120 :                             CStringGetDatum(constraint->relname));
    5764         120 :                 ScanKeyInit(&skey[1],
    5765             :                             Anum_pg_constraint_connamespace,
    5766             :                             BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    5767             :                             ObjectIdGetDatum(namespaceId));
    5768             : 
    5769         120 :                 conscan = systable_beginscan(conrel, ConstraintNameNspIndexId,
    5770             :                                              true, NULL, 2, skey);
    5771             : 
    5772         216 :                 while (HeapTupleIsValid(tup = systable_getnext(conscan)))
    5773             :                 {
    5774          96 :                     Form_pg_constraint con = (Form_pg_constraint) GETSTRUCT(tup);
    5775             : 
    5776          96 :                     if (con->condeferrable)
    5777          96 :                         conoidlist = lappend_oid(conoidlist, con->oid);
    5778           0 :                     else if (stmt->deferred)
    5779           0 :                         ereport(ERROR,
    5780             :                                 (errcode(ERRCODE_WRONG_OBJECT_TYPE),
    5781             :                                  errmsg("constraint \"%s\" is not deferrable",
    5782             :                                         constraint->relname)));
    5783          96 :                     found = true;
    5784             :                 }
    5785             : 
    5786         120 :                 systable_endscan(conscan);
    5787             : 
    5788             :                 /*
    5789             :                  * Once we've found a matching constraint we do not search
    5790             :                  * later parts of the search path.
    5791             :                  */
    5792         120 :                 if (found)
    5793          48 :                     break;
    5794             :             }
    5795             : 
    5796          48 :             list_free(namespacelist);
    5797             : 
    5798             :             /*
    5799             :              * Not found ?
    5800             :              */
    5801          48 :             if (!found)
    5802           0 :                 ereport(ERROR,
    5803             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
    5804             :                          errmsg("constraint \"%s\" does not exist",
    5805             :                                 constraint->relname)));
    5806             :         }
    5807             : 
    5808             :         /*
    5809             :          * Scan for any possible descendants of the constraints.  We append
    5810             :          * whatever we find to the same list that we're scanning; this has the
    5811             :          * effect that we create new scans for those, too, so if there are
    5812             :          * further descendents, we'll also catch them.
    5813             :          */
    5814         258 :         foreach(lc, conoidlist)
    5815             :         {
    5816         210 :             Oid         parent = lfirst_oid(lc);
    5817             :             ScanKeyData key;
    5818             :             SysScanDesc scan;
    5819             :             HeapTuple   tuple;
    5820             : 
    5821         210 :             ScanKeyInit(&key,
    5822             :                         Anum_pg_constraint_conparentid,
    5823             :                         BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    5824             :                         ObjectIdGetDatum(parent));
    5825             : 
    5826         210 :             scan = systable_beginscan(conrel, ConstraintParentIndexId, true, NULL, 1, &key);
    5827             : 
    5828         324 :             while (HeapTupleIsValid(tuple = systable_getnext(scan)))
    5829             :             {
    5830         114 :                 Form_pg_constraint con = (Form_pg_constraint) GETSTRUCT(tuple);
    5831             : 
    5832         114 :                 conoidlist = lappend_oid(conoidlist, con->oid);
    5833             :             }
    5834             : 
    5835         210 :             systable_endscan(scan);
    5836             :         }
    5837             : 
    5838          48 :         table_close(conrel, AccessShareLock);
    5839             : 
    5840             :         /*
    5841             :          * Now, locate the trigger(s) implementing each of these constraints,
    5842             :          * and make a list of their OIDs.
    5843             :          */
    5844          48 :         tgrel = table_open(TriggerRelationId, AccessShareLock);
    5845             : 
    5846         258 :         foreach(lc, conoidlist)
    5847             :         {
    5848         210 :             Oid         conoid = lfirst_oid(lc);
    5849             :             ScanKeyData skey;
    5850             :             SysScanDesc tgscan;
    5851             :             HeapTuple   htup;
    5852             : 
    5853         210 :             ScanKeyInit(&skey,
    5854             :                         Anum_pg_trigger_tgconstraint,
    5855             :                         BTEqualStrategyNumber, F_OIDEQ,
    5856             :                         ObjectIdGetDatum(conoid));
    5857             : 
    5858         210 :             tgscan = systable_beginscan(tgrel, TriggerConstraintIndexId, true,
    5859             :                                         NULL, 1, &skey);
    5860             : 
    5861         648 :             while (HeapTupleIsValid(htup = systable_getnext(tgscan)))
    5862             :             {
    5863         438 :                 Form_pg_trigger pg_trigger = (Form_pg_trigger) GETSTRUCT(htup);
    5864             : 
    5865             :                 /*
    5866             :                  * Silently skip triggers that are marked as non-deferrable in
    5867             :                  * pg_trigger.  This is not an error condition, since a
    5868             :                  * deferrable RI constraint may have some non-deferrable
    5869             :                  * actions.
    5870             :                  */
    5871         438 :                 if (pg_trigger->tgdeferrable)
    5872         438 :                     tgoidlist = lappend_oid(tgoidlist, pg_trigger->oid);
    5873             :             }
    5874             : 
    5875         210 :             systable_endscan(tgscan);
    5876             :         }
    5877             : 
    5878          48 :         table_close(tgrel, AccessShareLock);
    5879             : 
    5880             :         /*
    5881             :          * Now we can set the trigger states of individual triggers for this
    5882             :          * xact.
    5883             :          */
    5884         486 :         foreach(lc, tgoidlist)
    5885             :         {
    5886         438 :             Oid         tgoid = lfirst_oid(lc);
    5887         438 :             SetConstraintState state = afterTriggers.state;
    5888         438 :             bool        found = false;
    5889             :             int         i;
    5890             : 
    5891        2448 :             for (i = 0; i < state->numstates; i++)
    5892             :             {
    5893        2106 :                 if (state->trigstates[i].sct_tgoid == tgoid)
    5894             :                 {
    5895          96 :                     state->trigstates[i].sct_tgisdeferred = stmt->deferred;
    5896          96 :                     found = true;
    5897          96 :                     break;
    5898             :                 }
    5899             :             }
    5900         438 :             if (!found)
    5901             :             {
    5902         342 :                 afterTriggers.state =
    5903         342 :                     SetConstraintStateAddItem(state, tgoid, stmt->deferred);
    5904             :             }
    5905             :         }
    5906             :     }
    5907             : 
    5908             :     /*
    5909             :      * SQL99 requires that when a constraint is set to IMMEDIATE, any deferred
    5910             :      * checks against that constraint must be made when the SET CONSTRAINTS
    5911             :      * command is executed -- i.e. the effects of the SET CONSTRAINTS command
    5912             :      * apply retroactively.  We've updated the constraints state, so scan the
    5913             :      * list of previously deferred events to fire any that have now become
    5914             :      * immediate.
    5915             :      *
    5916             :      * Obviously, if this was SET ... DEFERRED then it can't have converted
    5917             :      * any unfired events to immediate, so we need do nothing in that case.
    5918             :      */
    5919         102 :     if (!stmt->deferred)
    5920             :     {
    5921          34 :         AfterTriggerEventList *events = &afterTriggers.events;
    5922          34 :         bool        snapshot_set = false;
    5923             : 
    5924          34 :         while (afterTriggerMarkEvents(events, NULL, true))
    5925             :         {
    5926          16 :             CommandId   firing_id = afterTriggers.firing_counter++;
    5927             : 
    5928             :             /*
    5929             :              * Make sure a snapshot has been established in case trigger
    5930             :              * functions need one.  Note that we avoid setting a snapshot if
    5931             :              * we don't find at least one trigger that has to be fired now.
    5932             :              * This is so that BEGIN; SET CONSTRAINTS ...; SET TRANSACTION
    5933             :              * ISOLATION LEVEL SERIALIZABLE; ... works properly.  (If we are
    5934             :              * at the start of a transaction it's not possible for any trigger
    5935             :              * events to be queued yet.)
    5936             :              */
    5937          16 :             if (!snapshot_set)
    5938             :             {
    5939          16 :                 PushActiveSnapshot(GetTransactionSnapshot());
    5940          16 :                 snapshot_set = true;
    5941             :             }
    5942             : 
    5943             :             /*
    5944             :              * We can delete fired events if we are at top transaction level,
    5945             :              * but we'd better not if inside a subtransaction, since the
    5946             :              * subtransaction could later get rolled back.
    5947             :              */
    5948           0 :             if (afterTriggerInvokeEvents(events, firing_id, NULL,
    5949          16 :                                          !IsSubTransaction()))
    5950           0 :                 break;          /* all fired */
    5951             :         }
    5952             : 
    5953          18 :         if (snapshot_set)
    5954           0 :             PopActiveSnapshot();
    5955             :     }
    5956          86 : }
    5957             : 
    5958             : /* ----------
    5959             :  * AfterTriggerPendingOnRel()
    5960             :  *      Test to see if there are any pending after-trigger events for rel.
    5961             :  *
    5962             :  * This is used by TRUNCATE, CLUSTER, ALTER TABLE, etc to detect whether
    5963             :  * it is unsafe to perform major surgery on a relation.  Note that only
    5964             :  * local pending events are examined.  We assume that having exclusive lock
    5965             :  * on a rel guarantees there are no unserviced events in other backends ---
    5966             :  * but having a lock does not prevent there being such events in our own.
    5967             :  *
    5968             :  * In some scenarios it'd be reasonable to remove pending events (more
    5969             :  * specifically, mark them DONE by the current subxact) but without a lot
    5970             :  * of knowledge of the trigger semantics we can't do this in general.
    5971             :  * ----------
    5972             :  */
    5973             : bool
    5974      106316 : AfterTriggerPendingOnRel(Oid relid)
    5975             : {
    5976             :     AfterTriggerEvent event;
    5977             :     AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    5978             :     int         depth;
    5979             : 
    5980             :     /* Scan queued events */
    5981      106340 :     for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.events)
    5982             :     {
    5983          30 :         AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    5984             : 
    5985             :         /*
    5986             :          * We can ignore completed events.  (Even if a DONE flag is rolled
    5987             :          * back by subxact abort, it's OK because the effects of the TRUNCATE
    5988             :          * or whatever must get rolled back too.)
    5989             :          */
    5990          30 :         if (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE)
    5991           0 :             continue;
    5992             : 
    5993          30 :         if (evtshared->ats_relid == relid)
    5994          18 :             return true;
    5995             :     }
    5996             : 
    5997             :     /*
    5998             :      * Also scan events queued by incomplete queries.  This could only matter
    5999             :      * if TRUNCATE/etc is executed by a function or trigger within an updating
    6000             :      * query on the same relation, which is pretty perverse, but let's check.
    6001             :      */
    6002      106298 :     for (depth = 0; depth <= afterTriggers.query_depth && depth < afterTriggers.maxquerydepth; depth++)
    6003             :     {
    6004           0 :         for_each_event_chunk(event, chunk, afterTriggers.query_stack[depth].events)
    6005             :         {
    6006           0 :             AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    6007             : 
    6008           0 :             if (event->ate_flags & AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE)
    6009           0 :                 continue;
    6010             : 
    6011           0 :             if (evtshared->ats_relid == relid)
    6012           0 :                 return true;
    6013             :         }
    6014             :     }
    6015             : 
    6016      106298 :     return false;
    6017             : }
    6018             : 
    6019             : /* ----------
    6020             :  * AfterTriggerSaveEvent()
    6021             :  *
    6022             :  *  Called by ExecA[RS]...Triggers() to queue up the triggers that should
    6023             :  *  be fired for an event.
    6024             :  *
    6025             :  *  NOTE: this is called whenever there are any triggers associated with
    6026             :  *  the event (even if they are disabled).  This function decides which
    6027             :  *  triggers actually need to be queued.  It is also called after each row,
    6028             :  *  even if there are no triggers for that event, if there are any AFTER
    6029             :  *  STATEMENT triggers for the statement which use transition tables, so that
    6030             :  *  the transition tuplestores can be built.  Furthermore, if the transition
    6031             :  *  capture is happening for UPDATEd rows being moved to another partition due
    6032             :  *  to the partition-key being changed, then this function is called once when
    6033             :  *  the row is deleted (to capture OLD row), and once when the row is inserted
    6034             :  *  into another partition (to capture NEW row).  This is done separately because
    6035             :  *  DELETE and INSERT happen on different tables.
    6036             :  *
    6037             :  *  Transition tuplestores are built now, rather than when events are pulled
    6038             :  *  off of the queue because AFTER ROW triggers are allowed to select from the
    6039             :  *  transition tables for the statement.
    6040             :  *
    6041             :  *  This contains special support to queue the update events for the case where
    6042             :  *  a partitioned table undergoing a cross-partition update may have foreign
    6043             :  *  keys pointing into it.  Normally, a partitioned table's row triggers are
    6044             :  *  not fired because the leaf partition(s) which are modified as a result of
    6045             :  *  the operation on the partitioned table contain the same triggers which are
    6046             :  *  fired instead. But that general scheme can cause problematic behavior with
    6047             :  *  foreign key triggers during cross-partition updates, which are implemented
    6048             :  *  as DELETE on the source partition followed by INSERT into the destination
    6049             :  *  partition.  Specifically, firing DELETE triggers would lead to the wrong
    6050             :  *  foreign key action to be enforced considering that the original command is
    6051             :  *  UPDATE; in this case, this function is called with relinfo as the
    6052             :  *  partitioned table, and src_partinfo and dst_partinfo referring to the
    6053             :  *  source and target leaf partitions, respectively.
    6054             :  *
    6055             :  *  is_crosspart_update is true either when a DELETE event is fired on the
    6056             :  *  source partition (which is to be ignored) or an UPDATE event is fired on
    6057             :  *  the root partitioned table.
    6058             :  * ----------
    6059             :  */
    6060             : static void
    6061       76396 : AfterTriggerSaveEvent(EState *estate, ResultRelInfo *relinfo,
    6062             :                       ResultRelInfo *src_partinfo,
    6063             :                       ResultRelInfo *dst_partinfo,
    6064             :                       int event, bool row_trigger,
    6065             :                       TupleTableSlot *oldslot, TupleTableSlot *newslot,
    6066             :                       List *recheckIndexes, Bitmapset *modifiedCols,
    6067             :                       TransitionCaptureState *transition_capture,
    6068             :                       bool is_crosspart_update)
    6069             : {
    6070       76396 :     Relation    rel = relinfo->ri_RelationDesc;
    6071       76396 :     TriggerDesc *trigdesc = relinfo->ri_TrigDesc;
    6072             :     AfterTriggerEventData new_event;
    6073             :     AfterTriggerSharedData new_shared;
    6074       76396 :     char        relkind = rel->rd_rel->relkind;
    6075             :     int         tgtype_event;
    6076             :     int         tgtype_level;
    6077             :     int         i;
    6078       76396 :     Tuplestorestate *fdw_tuplestore = NULL;
    6079             : 
    6080             :     /*
    6081             :      * Check state.  We use a normal test not Assert because it is possible to
    6082             :      * reach here in the wrong state given misconfigured RI triggers, in
    6083             :      * particular deferring a cascade action trigger.
    6084             :      */
    6085       76396 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    6086           0 :         elog(ERROR, "AfterTriggerSaveEvent() called outside of query");
    6087             : 
    6088             :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    6089       76396 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    6090        6116 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    6091             : 
    6092             :     /*
    6093             :      * If the directly named relation has any triggers with transition tables,
    6094             :      * then we need to capture transition tuples.
    6095             :      */
    6096       76396 :     if (row_trigger && transition_capture != NULL)
    6097             :     {
    6098       65772 :         TupleTableSlot *original_insert_tuple = transition_capture->tcs_original_insert_tuple;
    6099             : 
    6100             :         /*
    6101             :          * Capture the old tuple in the appropriate transition table based on
    6102             :          * the event.
    6103             :          */
    6104       65772 :         if (!TupIsNull(oldslot))
    6105             :         {
    6106             :             Tuplestorestate *old_tuplestore;
    6107             : 
    6108        5394 :             old_tuplestore = GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(event,
    6109             :                                                              oldslot,
    6110             :                                                              NULL,
    6111             :                                                              transition_capture);
    6112        5394 :             TransitionTableAddTuple(estate, transition_capture, relinfo,
    6113             :                                     oldslot, NULL, old_tuplestore);
    6114             :         }
    6115             : 
    6116             :         /*
    6117             :          * Capture the new tuple in the appropriate transition table based on
    6118             :          * the event.
    6119             :          */
    6120       65772 :         if (!TupIsNull(newslot))
    6121             :         {
    6122             :             Tuplestorestate *new_tuplestore;
    6123             : 
    6124       60690 :             new_tuplestore = GetAfterTriggersTransitionTable(event,
    6125             :                                                              NULL,
    6126             :                                                              newslot,
    6127             :                                                              transition_capture);
    6128       60690 :             TransitionTableAddTuple(estate, transition_capture, relinfo,
    6129             :                                     newslot, original_insert_tuple, new_tuplestore);
    6130             :         }
    6131             : 
    6132             :         /*
    6133             :          * If transition tables are the only reason we're here, return. As
    6134             :          * mentioned above, we can also be here during update tuple routing in
    6135             :          * presence of transition tables, in which case this function is
    6136             :          * called separately for OLD and NEW, so we expect exactly one of them
    6137             :          * to be NULL.
    6138             :          */
    6139       65772 :         if (trigdesc == NULL ||
    6140       65568 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE && !trigdesc->trig_delete_after_row) ||
    6141       60588 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT && !trigdesc->trig_insert_after_row) ||
    6142         354 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && !trigdesc->trig_update_after_row) ||
    6143          36 :             (event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE && (TupIsNull(oldslot) ^ TupIsNull(newslot))))
    6144       65658 :             return;
    6145             :     }
    6146             : 
    6147             :     /*
    6148             :      * We normally don't see partitioned tables here for row level triggers
    6149             :      * except in the special case of a cross-partition update.  In that case,
    6150             :      * nodeModifyTable.c:ExecCrossPartitionUpdateForeignKey() calls here to
    6151             :      * queue an update event on the root target partitioned table, also
    6152             :      * passing the source and destination partitions and their tuples.
    6153             :      */
    6154             :     Assert(!row_trigger ||
    6155             :            rel->rd_rel->relkind != RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE ||
    6156             :            (is_crosspart_update &&
    6157             :             TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event) &&
    6158             :             src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL));
    6159             : 
    6160             :     /*
    6161             :      * Validate the event code and collect the associated tuple CTIDs.
    6162             :      *
    6163             :      * The event code will be used both as a bitmask and an array offset, so
    6164             :      * validation is important to make sure we don't walk off the edge of our
    6165             :      * arrays.
    6166             :      *
    6167             :      * Also, if we're considering statement-level triggers, check whether we
    6168             :      * already queued a set of them for this event, and cancel the prior set
    6169             :      * if so.  This preserves the behavior that statement-level triggers fire
    6170             :      * just once per statement and fire after row-level triggers.
    6171             :      */
    6172       10738 :     switch (event)
    6173             :     {
    6174        5688 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_INSERT:
    6175        5688 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_INSERT;
    6176        5688 :             if (row_trigger)
    6177             :             {
    6178             :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6179             :                 Assert(newslot != NULL);
    6180        5240 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(newslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6181        5240 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6182             :             }
    6183             :             else
    6184             :             {
    6185             :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6186             :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6187         448 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6188         448 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6189         448 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6190             :                                            CMD_INSERT, event);
    6191             :             }
    6192        5688 :             break;
    6193        1420 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_DELETE:
    6194        1420 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_DELETE;
    6195        1420 :             if (row_trigger)
    6196             :             {
    6197             :                 Assert(oldslot != NULL);
    6198             :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6199        1190 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(oldslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6200        1190 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6201             :             }
    6202             :             else
    6203             :             {
    6204             :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6205             :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6206         230 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6207         230 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6208         230 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6209             :                                            CMD_DELETE, event);
    6210             :             }
    6211        1420 :             break;
    6212        3622 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE:
    6213        3622 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_UPDATE;
    6214        3622 :             if (row_trigger)
    6215             :             {
    6216             :                 Assert(oldslot != NULL);
    6217             :                 Assert(newslot != NULL);
    6218        3226 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(oldslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6219        3226 :                 ItemPointerCopy(&(newslot->tts_tid), &(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6220             : 
    6221             :                 /*
    6222             :                  * Also remember the OIDs of partitions to fetch these tuples
    6223             :                  * out of later in AfterTriggerExecute().
    6224             :                  */
    6225        3226 :                 if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6226             :                 {
    6227             :                     Assert(src_partinfo != NULL && dst_partinfo != NULL);
    6228         258 :                     new_event.ate_src_part =
    6229         258 :                         RelationGetRelid(src_partinfo->ri_RelationDesc);
    6230         258 :                     new_event.ate_dst_part =
    6231         258 :                         RelationGetRelid(dst_partinfo->ri_RelationDesc);
    6232             :                 }
    6233             :             }
    6234             :             else
    6235             :             {
    6236             :                 Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6237             :                 Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6238         396 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6239         396 :                 ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6240         396 :                 cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(RelationGetRelid(rel),
    6241             :                                            CMD_UPDATE, event);
    6242             :             }
    6243        3622 :             break;
    6244           8 :         case TRIGGER_EVENT_TRUNCATE:
    6245           8 :             tgtype_event = TRIGGER_TYPE_TRUNCATE;
    6246             :             Assert(oldslot == NULL);
    6247             :             Assert(newslot == NULL);
    6248           8 :             ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid1));
    6249           8 :             ItemPointerSetInvalid(&(new_event.ate_ctid2));
    6250           8 :             break;
    6251           0 :         default:
    6252           0 :             elog(ERROR, "invalid after-trigger event code: %d", event);
    6253             :             tgtype_event = 0;   /* keep compiler quiet */
    6254             :             break;
    6255             :     }
    6256             : 
    6257             :     /* Determine flags */
    6258       10738 :     if (!(relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE && row_trigger))
    6259             :     {
    6260       10682 :         if (row_trigger && event == TRIGGER_EVENT_UPDATE)
    6261             :         {
    6262        3206 :             if (relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6263         258 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_CP_UPDATE;
    6264             :             else
    6265        2948 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_2CTID;
    6266             :         }
    6267             :         else
    6268        7476 :             new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_1CTID;
    6269             :     }
    6270             : 
    6271             :     /* else, we'll initialize ate_flags for each trigger */
    6272             : 
    6273       10738 :     tgtype_level = (row_trigger ? TRIGGER_TYPE_ROW : TRIGGER_TYPE_STATEMENT);
    6274             : 
    6275             :     /*
    6276             :      * Must convert/copy the source and destination partition tuples into the
    6277             :      * root partitioned table's format/slot, because the processing in the
    6278             :      * loop below expects both oldslot and newslot tuples to be in that form.
    6279             :      */
    6280       10738 :     if (row_trigger && rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6281             :     {
    6282             :         TupleTableSlot *rootslot;
    6283             :         TupleConversionMap *map;
    6284             : 
    6285         258 :         rootslot = ExecGetTriggerOldSlot(estate, relinfo);
    6286         258 :         map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(src_partinfo);
    6287         258 :         if (map)
    6288          36 :             oldslot = execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    6289             :                                             oldslot,
    6290             :                                             rootslot);
    6291             :         else
    6292         222 :             oldslot = ExecCopySlot(rootslot, oldslot);
    6293             : 
    6294         258 :         rootslot = ExecGetTriggerNewSlot(estate, relinfo);
    6295         258 :         map = ExecGetChildToRootMap(dst_partinfo);
    6296         258 :         if (map)
    6297          36 :             newslot = execute_attr_map_slot(map->attrMap,
    6298             :                                             newslot,
    6299             :                                             rootslot);
    6300             :         else
    6301         222 :             newslot = ExecCopySlot(rootslot, newslot);
    6302             :     }
    6303             : 
    6304       49272 :     for (i = 0; i < trigdesc->numtriggers; i++)
    6305             :     {
    6306       38534 :         Trigger    *trigger = &trigdesc->triggers[i];
    6307             : 
    6308       38534 :         if (!TRIGGER_TYPE_MATCHES(trigger->tgtype,
    6309             :                                   tgtype_level,
    6310             :                                   TRIGGER_TYPE_AFTER,
    6311             :                                   tgtype_event))
    6312       24832 :             continue;
    6313       13702 :         if (!TriggerEnabled(estate, relinfo, trigger, event,
    6314             :                             modifiedCols, oldslot, newslot))
    6315         368 :             continue;
    6316             : 
    6317       13334 :         if (relkind == RELKIND_FOREIGN_TABLE && row_trigger)
    6318             :         {
    6319          58 :             if (fdw_tuplestore == NULL)
    6320             :             {
    6321          50 :                 fdw_tuplestore = GetCurrentFDWTuplestore();
    6322          50 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_FETCH;
    6323             :             }
    6324             :             else
    6325             :                 /* subsequent event for the same tuple */
    6326           8 :                 new_event.ate_flags = AFTER_TRIGGER_FDW_REUSE;
    6327             :         }
    6328             : 
    6329             :         /*
    6330             :          * If the trigger is a foreign key enforcement trigger, there are
    6331             :          * certain cases where we can skip queueing the event because we can
    6332             :          * tell by inspection that the FK constraint will still pass. There
    6333             :          * are also some cases during cross-partition updates of a partitioned
    6334             :          * table where queuing the event can be skipped.
    6335             :          */
    6336       13334 :         if (TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_UPDATE(event) || TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(event))
    6337             :         {
    6338        6460 :             switch (RI_FKey_trigger_type(trigger->tgfoid))
    6339             :             {
    6340        2554 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_PK:
    6341             : 
    6342             :                     /*
    6343             :                      * For cross-partitioned updates of partitioned PK table,
    6344             :                      * skip the event fired by the component delete on the
    6345             :                      * source leaf partition unless the constraint originates
    6346             :                      * in the partition itself (!tgisclone), because the
    6347             :                      * update event that will be fired on the root
    6348             :                      * (partitioned) target table will be used to perform the
    6349             :                      * necessary foreign key enforcement action.
    6350             :                      */
    6351        2554 :                     if (is_crosspart_update &&
    6352         498 :                         TRIGGER_FIRED_BY_DELETE(event) &&
    6353         264 :                         trigger->tgisclone)
    6354         246 :                         continue;
    6355             : 
    6356             :                     /* Update or delete on trigger's PK table */
    6357        2308 :                     if (!RI_FKey_pk_upd_check_required(trigger, rel,
    6358             :                                                        oldslot, newslot))
    6359             :                     {
    6360             :                         /* skip queuing this event */
    6361         542 :                         continue;
    6362             :                     }
    6363        1766 :                     break;
    6364             : 
    6365        1158 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_FK:
    6366             : 
    6367             :                     /*
    6368             :                      * Update on trigger's FK table.  We can skip the update
    6369             :                      * event fired on a partitioned table during a
    6370             :                      * cross-partition of that table, because the insert event
    6371             :                      * that is fired on the destination leaf partition would
    6372             :                      * suffice to perform the necessary foreign key check.
    6373             :                      * Moreover, RI_FKey_fk_upd_check_required() expects to be
    6374             :                      * passed a tuple that contains system attributes, most of
    6375             :                      * which are not present in the virtual slot belonging to
    6376             :                      * a partitioned table.
    6377             :                      */
    6378        1158 :                     if (rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE ||
    6379        1068 :                         !RI_FKey_fk_upd_check_required(trigger, rel,
    6380             :                                                        oldslot, newslot))
    6381             :                     {
    6382             :                         /* skip queuing this event */
    6383         686 :                         continue;
    6384             :                     }
    6385         472 :                     break;
    6386             : 
    6387        2748 :                 case RI_TRIGGER_NONE:
    6388             : 
    6389             :                     /*
    6390             :                      * Not an FK trigger.  No need to queue the update event
    6391             :                      * fired during a cross-partitioned update of a
    6392             :                      * partitioned table, because the same row trigger must be
    6393             :                      * present in the leaf partition(s) that are affected as
    6394             :                      * part of this update and the events fired on them are
    6395             :                      * queued instead.
    6396             :                      */
    6397        2748 :                     if (row_trigger &&
    6398        2086 :                         rel->rd_rel->relkind == RELKIND_PARTITIONED_TABLE)
    6399          30 :                         continue;
    6400        2718 :                     break;
    6401             :             }
    6402        6874 :         }
    6403             : 
    6404             :         /*
    6405             :          * If the trigger is a deferred unique constraint check trigger, only
    6406             :          * queue it if the unique constraint was potentially violated, which
    6407             :          * we know from index insertion time.
    6408             :          */
    6409       11830 :         if (trigger->tgfoid == F_UNIQUE_KEY_RECHECK)
    6410             :         {
    6411         210 :             if (!list_member_oid(recheckIndexes, trigger->tgconstrindid))
    6412          88 :                 continue;       /* Uniqueness definitely not violated */
    6413             :         }
    6414             : 
    6415             :         /*
    6416             :          * Fill in event structure and add it to the current query's queue.
    6417             :          * Note we set ats_table to NULL whenever this trigger doesn't use
    6418             :          * transition tables, to improve sharability of the shared event data.
    6419             :          */
    6420       11742 :         new_shared.ats_event =
    6421       23484 :             (event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) |
    6422       11742 :             (row_trigger ? TRIGGER_EVENT_ROW : 0) |
    6423       11742 :             (trigger->tgdeferrable ? AFTER_TRIGGER_DEFERRABLE : 0) |
    6424       11742 :             (trigger->tginitdeferred ? AFTER_TRIGGER_INITDEFERRED : 0);
    6425       11742 :         new_shared.ats_tgoid = trigger->tgoid;
    6426       11742 :         new_shared.ats_relid = RelationGetRelid(rel);
    6427       11742 :         new_shared.ats_firing_id = 0;
    6428       11742 :         if ((trigger->tgoldtable || trigger->tgnewtable) &&
    6429             :             transition_capture != NULL)
    6430         606 :             new_shared.ats_table = transition_capture->tcs_private;
    6431             :         else
    6432       11136 :             new_shared.ats_table = NULL;
    6433       11742 :         new_shared.ats_modifiedcols = afterTriggerCopyBitmap(modifiedCols);
    6434             : 
    6435       11742 :         afterTriggerAddEvent(&afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth].events,
    6436             :                              &new_event, &new_shared);
    6437             :     }
    6438             : 
    6439             :     /*
    6440             :      * Finally, spool any foreign tuple(s).  The tuplestore squashes them to
    6441             :      * minimal tuples, so this loses any system columns.  The executor lost
    6442             :      * those columns before us, for an unrelated reason, so this is fine.
    6443             :      */
    6444       10738 :     if (fdw_tuplestore)
    6445             :     {
    6446          50 :         if (oldslot != NULL)
    6447          32 :             tuplestore_puttupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, oldslot);
    6448          50 :         if (newslot != NULL)
    6449          36 :             tuplestore_puttupleslot(fdw_tuplestore, newslot);
    6450             :     }
    6451             : }
    6452             : 
    6453             : /*
    6454             :  * Detect whether we already queued BEFORE STATEMENT triggers for the given
    6455             :  * relation + operation, and set the flag so the next call will report "true".
    6456             :  */
    6457             : static bool
    6458         510 : before_stmt_triggers_fired(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType)
    6459             : {
    6460             :     bool        result;
    6461             :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    6462             : 
    6463             :     /* Check state, like AfterTriggerSaveEvent. */
    6464         510 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth < 0)
    6465           0 :         elog(ERROR, "before_stmt_triggers_fired() called outside of query");
    6466             : 
    6467             :     /* Be sure we have enough space to record events at this query depth. */
    6468         510 :     if (afterTriggers.query_depth >= afterTriggers.maxquerydepth)
    6469         336 :         AfterTriggerEnlargeQueryState();
    6470             : 
    6471             :     /*
    6472             :      * We keep this state in the AfterTriggersTableData that also holds
    6473             :      * transition tables for the relation + operation.  In this way, if we are
    6474             :      * forced to make a new set of transition tables because more tuples get
    6475             :      * entered after we've already fired triggers, we will allow a new set of
    6476             :      * statement triggers to get queued.
    6477             :      */
    6478         510 :     table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, cmdType);
    6479         510 :     result = table->before_trig_done;
    6480         510 :     table->before_trig_done = true;
    6481         510 :     return result;
    6482             : }
    6483             : 
    6484             : /*
    6485             :  * If we previously queued a set of AFTER STATEMENT triggers for the given
    6486             :  * relation + operation, and they've not been fired yet, cancel them.  The
    6487             :  * caller will queue a fresh set that's after any row-level triggers that may
    6488             :  * have been queued by the current sub-statement, preserving (as much as
    6489             :  * possible) the property that AFTER ROW triggers fire before AFTER STATEMENT
    6490             :  * triggers, and that the latter only fire once.  This deals with the
    6491             :  * situation where several FK enforcement triggers sequentially queue triggers
    6492             :  * for the same table into the same trigger query level.  We can't fully
    6493             :  * prevent odd behavior though: if there are AFTER ROW triggers taking
    6494             :  * transition tables, we don't want to change the transition tables once the
    6495             :  * first such trigger has seen them.  In such a case, any additional events
    6496             :  * will result in creating new transition tables and allowing new firings of
    6497             :  * statement triggers.
    6498             :  *
    6499             :  * This also saves the current event list location so that a later invocation
    6500             :  * of this function can cheaply find the triggers we're about to queue and
    6501             :  * cancel them.
    6502             :  */
    6503             : static void
    6504        1074 : cancel_prior_stmt_triggers(Oid relid, CmdType cmdType, int tgevent)
    6505             : {
    6506             :     AfterTriggersTableData *table;
    6507        1074 :     AfterTriggersQueryData *qs = &afterTriggers.query_stack[afterTriggers.query_depth];
    6508             : 
    6509             :     /*
    6510             :      * We keep this state in the AfterTriggersTableData that also holds
    6511             :      * transition tables for the relation + operation.  In this way, if we are
    6512             :      * forced to make a new set of transition tables because more tuples get
    6513             :      * entered after we've already fired triggers, we will allow a new set of
    6514             :      * statement triggers to get queued without canceling the old ones.
    6515             :      */
    6516        1074 :     table = GetAfterTriggersTableData(relid, cmdType);
    6517             : 
    6518        1074 :     if (table->after_trig_done)
    6519             :     {
    6520             :         /*
    6521             :          * We want to start scanning from the tail location that existed just
    6522             :          * before we inserted any statement triggers.  But the events list
    6523             :          * might've been entirely empty then, in which case scan from the
    6524             :          * current head.
    6525             :          */
    6526             :         AfterTriggerEvent event;
    6527             :         AfterTriggerEventChunk *chunk;
    6528             : 
    6529          66 :         if (table->after_trig_events.tail)
    6530             :         {
    6531          60 :             chunk = table->after_trig_events.tail;
    6532          60 :             event = (AfterTriggerEvent) table->after_trig_events.tailfree;
    6533             :         }
    6534             :         else
    6535             :         {
    6536           6 :             chunk = qs->events.head;
    6537           6 :             event = NULL;
    6538             :         }
    6539             : 
    6540          96 :         for_each_chunk_from(chunk)
    6541             :         {
    6542          66 :             if (event == NULL)
    6543           6 :                 event = (AfterTriggerEvent) CHUNK_DATA_START(chunk);
    6544         138 :             for_each_event_from(event, chunk)
    6545             :             {
    6546         108 :                 AfterTriggerShared evtshared = GetTriggerSharedData(event);
    6547             : 
    6548             :                 /*
    6549             :                  * Exit loop when we reach events that aren't AS triggers for
    6550             :                  * the target relation.
    6551             :                  */
    6552         108 :                 if (evtshared->ats_relid != relid)
    6553           0 :                     goto done;
    6554         108 :                 if ((evtshared->ats_event & TRIGGER_EVENT_OPMASK) != tgevent)
    6555           0 :                     goto done;
    6556         108 :                 if (!TRIGGER_FIRED_FOR_STATEMENT(evtshared->ats_event))
    6557          36 :                     goto done;
    6558          72 :                 if (!TRIGGER_FIRED_AFTER(evtshared->ats_event))
    6559           0 :                     goto done;
    6560             :                 /* OK, mark it DONE */
    6561          72 :                 event->ate_flags &= ~AFTER_TRIGGER_IN_PROGRESS;
    6562          72 :                 event->ate_flags |= AFTER_TRIGGER_DONE;
    6563             :             }
    6564             :             /* signal we must reinitialize event ptr for next chunk */
    6565          30 :             event = NULL;
    6566             :         }
    6567             :     }
    6568        1038 : done:
    6569             : 
    6570             :     /* In any case, save current insertion point for next time */
    6571        1074 :     table->after_trig_done = true;
    6572        1074 :     table->after_trig_events = qs->events;
    6573        1074 : }
    6574             : 
    6575             : /*
    6576             :  * GUC assign_hook for session_replication_role
    6577             :  */
    6578             : void
    6579        2600 : assign_session_replication_role(int newval, void *extra)
    6580             : {
    6581             :     /*
    6582             :      * Must flush the plan cache when changing replication role; but don't
    6583             :      * flush unnecessarily.
    6584             :      */
    6585        2600 :     if (SessionReplicationRole != newval)
    6586         770 :         ResetPlanCache();
    6587        2600 : }
    6588             : 
    6589             : /*
    6590             :  * SQL function pg_trigger_depth()
    6591             :  */
    6592             : Datum
    6593          90 : pg_trigger_depth(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
    6594             : {
    6595          90 :     PG_RETURN_INT32(MyTriggerDepth);
    6596             : }

Generated by: LCOV version 1.14